SCHOOL OF ARCHITECTURE, SCIENCE AND TECHNOLOGY YASHWANTRAO CHAVAN MAHARASHTRA OPEN UNIVERSITY Detail Syllabus for Semester 01 to 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} 2014 A S T, YC M O U , N a s h i k – 4 2 2 2 2 2 , M S , I n d i a CONTENTS Basic Information ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 7 Programme Calendar ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 7 Eligibility and Fees ........................................................................................................................................................................................... 7 Semesters and Courses .................................................................................................................................................................................... 8 Evaluation Pattern ........................................................................................................................................................................................... 9 Semester 01 ........................................................................................................................................................................................................10 T14011: Basic Science .....................................................................................................................................................................................10 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 10 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 10 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 11 T14012: Basic Mathematics.............................................................................................................................................................................13 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 13 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 13 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 13 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 13 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 13 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 14 T14013: Technical Communication ..................................................................................................................................................................15 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 15 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 15 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 15 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 15 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 15 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 16 T14014: Engineering Mechanics ......................................................................................................................................................................17 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 17 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 17 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 17 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 17 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 17 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 18 T14015: TC, PP AND SOFT-Skills .......................................................................................................................................................................20 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 20 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 20 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 20 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 21 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 22 T14016: Computer Basics and Basic Science .....................................................................................................................................................24 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 24 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 24 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 24 Part I: Computer Basics ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 24 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 24 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 25 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 28 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 29 Part II: Basic Science .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 29 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 29 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 29 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 30 Semester 02 ........................................................................................................................................................................................................31 T14021: Applied Science .................................................................................................................................................................................31 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 31 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 31 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 31 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 31 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 32 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 33 T14022: Applied Mathematics-1......................................................................................................................................................................34 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 34 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 34 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 1 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 34 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 34 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 34 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 35 T14023: Electronic Components & Applications ...............................................................................................................................................36 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 36 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 36 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 36 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 36 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 36 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 37 T14024: Engineering Drawing-2 .......................................................................................................................................................................38 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 38 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 38 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 38 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 38 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 38 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 39 T14025: Workshop Practice (Programme specific) ............................................................................................................................................40 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 40 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 40 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 40 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 40 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 40 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 41 T14026: Applied Science and Engineering Drawing-1........................................................................................................................................43 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 43 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 43 Part I: Applied Science ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 43 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 43 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 43 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 43 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 44 Part II: Engineering Drawing -1.................................................................................................................................................................................... 45 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 45 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 45 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 45 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 46 Semester 03 ........................................................................................................................................................................................................47 T14031: Basic Electronics ................................................................................................................................................................................47 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 47 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 47 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 47 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 47 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 47 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 49 T14032: Applied Mathematics-2......................................................................................................................................................................50 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 50 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 50 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 50 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 50 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 50 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 51 T14033: Basic Electrical Engineering ................................................................................................................................................................52 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 52 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 52 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 52 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 52 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 52 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 53 T14034: Electrical and Electronics Measurement..............................................................................................................................................55 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 55 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 55 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 55 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 55 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 55 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 56 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 2 T14035: Computer Programming.....................................................................................................................................................................57 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 57 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 57 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 57 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 57 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 58 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 59 T14036: Basic Electronics, Electrical and Measurement ....................................................................................................................................60 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 60 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 60 Part I: Basic Electronics................................................................................................................................................................................................ 60 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 60 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 60 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 60 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 61 Part II: Basic Electrical And Measurement .................................................................................................................................................................. 61 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 61 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 62 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 62 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 62 Semester 04 ........................................................................................................................................................................................................64 T14041: Industrial Instrumentation .................................................................................................................................................................64 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 64 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 64 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 64 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 64 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 64 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 65 T14042: Transformers and DC Machines ..........................................................................................................................................................66 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 66 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 66 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 66 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 66 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 66 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 67 T14043: AC Machines .....................................................................................................................................................................................69 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 69 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 69 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 69 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 69 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 69 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 70 T14044: Electrical Power Generation ...............................................................................................................................................................72 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 72 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 72 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 72 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 72 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 72 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 73 Scilab Textbook Companion for Principles of Power Systems .................................................................................................................................. 73 T14045: Industrial Instrumentation and Basic Mechanical Engineering .............................................................................................................74 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 74 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 74 Part I: Industrial Instrumentation ................................................................................................................................................................................ 74 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 74 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 74 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 74 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 75 Part II: Basic Mechanical Engineering ......................................................................................................................................................................... 75 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 75 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 75 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 76 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 76 T14046: Transformers, DC and AC Machines ....................................................................................................................................................78 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 78 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 78 Part I: Transformers and DC Machines ........................................................................................................................................................................ 78 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 3 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 78 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 78 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 78 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 79 Part II: AC Machines .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 79 resumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ............................................................................................................................................................. 79 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 79 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 79 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 80 Semester 05 ........................................................................................................................................................................................................81 T14051: Industry Electrical Systems .................................................................................................................................................................81 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 81 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 81 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 81 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 81 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 81 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 82 T14052: Microcontroller .................................................................................................................................................................................84 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 84 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 84 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 84 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 84 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 84 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 85 T14053: Power Electronics ..............................................................................................................................................................................86 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 86 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 86 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 86 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 86 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 86 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 87 T14054: Electrical Power Transmission and Distribution ...................................................................................................................................89 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 89 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 89 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 89 Units ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 89 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 89 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 90 T14055: Industry Electrical Systems and Energy Conservation & Audit ..............................................................................................................92 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 92 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 92 Part I: Industry Electrical Systems ................................................................................................................................................................................ 92 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 92 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 92 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 92 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 93 Part II: Energy Conservation & Audit........................................................................................................................................................................... 93 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 93 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 93 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 94 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 95 T14056: Microcontroller and Power Electronics ...............................................................................................................................................96 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 96 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 96 Part I: Microcontroller ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 96 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 96 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 96 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 96 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 97 Part II: Power Electronics............................................................................................................................................................................................. 97 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 97 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory .............................................................................................................................................................................. 97 Detail Practical Activities .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 97 Learning Resource Details ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 98 Semester 06 ........................................................................................................................................................................................................99 T14061: Industrial Management .....................................................................................................................................................................99 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................... 99 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 4 Course Information ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 99 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 99 Detail Syllabus .............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 99 Learning Resource Details .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 100 T14062: Switchgear & Protection .................................................................................................................................................................. 101 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................. 101 Course Information .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 101 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ......................................................................................................................................................... 101 Units ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 101 Detail Syllabus ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 101 Learning Resource Details .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 102 T14063: Electrical Testing and Maintenance ................................................................................................................................................... 104 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................. 104 Course Information .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 104 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ......................................................................................................................................................... 104 Units ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 104 Detail Syllabus ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 104 Learning Resource Details .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 106 Elective - I: Anyone of course from T14064 or T15064 .................................................................................................................................... 107 T14064: Illumination Engineering .................................................................................................................................................................. 107 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................. 107 Course Information .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 107 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ......................................................................................................................................................... 107 Units ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 107 Detail Syllabus ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 107 Learning Resource Details .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 108 T15064: Modern Electric Traction .................................................................................................................................................................. 110 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................. 110 Course Information .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 110 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ......................................................................................................................................................... 110 Units ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 110 Detail Syllabus ............................................................................................................................................................................................................ 110 Learning Resource Details .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 111 T14065: Project-Work ................................................................................................................................................................................... 112 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................. 112 Course Information .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 112 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ......................................................................................................................................................... 112 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory ............................................................................................................................................................................ 112 Detail Practical Activities ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 113 Learning Resource Details .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 114 T14066: Electrical Testing and Maintenance and Activity Course on Elective 1 ................................................................................................. 116 Programme Information............................................................................................................................................................................................. 116 Course Information .................................................................................................................................................................................................... 116 Part I: T14063: ELECTRICAL TESTING AND MAINTENANCE ....................................................................................................................................... 116 Presumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ......................................................................................................................................................... 116 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory ............................................................................................................................................................................ 116 Detail Practical Activities ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 116 Learning Resource Details .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 117 Part II: Elective 1: T14064: Illumination Engineering ................................................................................................................................................ 117 resumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 117 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory ............................................................................................................................................................................ 117 Detail Practical Activities ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 118 Learning Resource Details .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 118 Part II: Elective 1: T15064: Modern Electric Traction ................................................................................................................................................ 118 resumed Knowledge and Learning Objectives ........................................................................................................................................................... 119 Detail Syllabus of Required Theory ............................................................................................................................................................................ 119 Detail Practical Activities ............................................................................................................................................................................................ 119 Learning Resource Details .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 119 End of Document .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 120 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 5 PROGRAMME ADVISORY COMMITTEE (PAC) V55: DIPLOMA IN ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING (DEE) {2014 PATTERN} SN 01 Members Dr. Manoj Killedar, The Director, School of Architecture, Science and Technology, Internal YCMOU Member (M: 940 377 4504), Email: killedar_ms@ycmou.digitaluniversity.ac, manoj.killedar@live.com 02 Dr Sunanda More, Internal YCMOU Member (M: 940 377 4750), Email: more_sa@ycmou.digitaluniversity.ac, sunandarun@yahoo.com 03 Mrs Chetana Kamlaskar, Internal YCMOU Member (M: 940 377 4531), Email: kamlaskar_ch@ycmou.digitaluniversity.ac, chetana.kamlaskar@gmail.com 04 Prof S S Ashtputre, MSBTE/DTE Nominee (M:094 228 73608 ), Email: sunil8son@yahoo.com 05 Prof L S Patil, External Academic Expert (M: 094 227 90573), Email: lspatil@rediffmail.com 06 Ms. Barnali Motling, External Academic Expert (M: 098 335 70782), Email: principal@polytech.somaiya.edu, b_padmaja@hotmail.com 07 Mrs. Tanuja Date, External Academic Expert (M: 98 508 32871), Email: tndate@kkwagh.edu.in 08 Mr. Omprakash Kulkarni, External Industry Expert (M:094 222 45346 ), Email: kulkarnismo@gmail.com 09 Mr. Umesh Joharapurkar, External Industry Expert (M: 98 220 15681), Email: technogem@vsnl.vom, : tgem@pn3.vsnl.net.in 10 Mr. Santosh Dongaonkar, External Industry Expert (M: 094 040 94247), Email: svdongaonkar@gmail.com SYLLABUS OF ALL COURSES AT SEMESTER 01 AND 02 WERE FINALIZED BASED ON THE FIRST AND SECOND SEMESTER COURSES OF V62 AND V63 PROGRAMME . SYLLABUS OF ALL COURSES AT SEMESTER 03 AND 04 WERE FINALIZED IN PAC MEETING HELD ON 02 MAR 2015. SYLLABUS OF ALL COURSES AT SEMESTER 05 AND 06 WERE FINALIZED IN PAC MEETING HELD ON 04 FEB 2016. Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 6 V55: DIPLOMA IN ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING {2014 PATTERN} BASIC INFORMATION 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Mode of Education: Full time face-to-face mode enhanced with ELearning support. Minimum Programme Duration: 3 years after SSC (10th) Required Study Efforts: 720 Hours in each semester Medium of Instruction: English Attendance: Minimum 80% attendance for all courses. Equivalence Status: UGC recognized and approved DEC recognized and approved PROGRAMME CALENDAR SN Activity Description Odd semesters like 01, 03, 05 and 07 From 01-Aug Till 31 Jan Even semesters like 02, 04, 06 and 08 From 01-Feb Till 31-Jul Annual Admission 01 Further Admission From 05-Jun Till 05-Jul Not Offered 02 Fresh Admission From 05-Jun Till 05-Aug Not Offered Teaching – Learning 03 Teaching - Learning From 01-Aug Till 13 Nov From 01-Feb Till 16-May 04 Teaching–Learning Backlog Clearing From 14-Nov to 04-Dec From 17-May to 04-Jun End Exam (EE) Form Submission 05 EE Form Submission by students at SC On or Before 30-Sep On or Before 31-Mar 06 EE Form Submission by SCs at University On or Before 05-Oct On or Before 05-Apr From 01-Aug Till 30 Nov From 01-Feb Till 30-May Continuous Assessment (CA) Submission 07 CA Availability on website 08 CA Submission by Students at SC 09 10 01-30 Nov 01-30 May Provisional CA Report by SCs On or before 31-Dec On or before 30-Jun Final CA Report Submission by SCs at University On or before 31-Jan On or before 31-Jul End Examination (EE) 11 EE for Theory Courses 12 EE for Practical, STW, SV or PW Courses From 05-Dec Till 14-Dec From 05-Jun Till 14-Jun Immediately after the last day of end exam for theory courses, but positively before 05-Jan Immediately after the last day of end exam for theory courses, but positively before 05-Jul From 08-Jan Till 31-Jan From 08-Jul Till 31-Jul Semester End Vacation 13 Semester End Vacation ELIGIBILITY AND FEES Admission Eligibility Certification Eligibility SSC (10th) or Equivalent Exam passed from recognized board Min 50% or better marks in total 36 courses (subjects) of total 144 Credit points at Semesters 01-06 Aggregate performance and Class in the programme shall be reported on the basis of only semesters 05 and 06. Fees and Deposit / Semester Desc INR UF ₹ 3,600 SCF ₹ 8,400 EF (Only for repeat ₹ 100 / T attempts. Included in UF ₹ 200 / TW for first compulsory ₹ 300 / P attempt) ₹ 400 / PW Total ₹ 12,000 AAFA LD ₹ 7,200 ₹ 2,000 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} USD US$ 360 US$ 840 US$ 10 / T US$ 20 / TW US$ 30 / P US$ 40 / PW US$ 1,200 US$ 720 US$ 200 Page 7 SEMESTERS AND COURSES All courses at “both semesters at each year” shall be finalized in phased manner. V55 – DEE – All Course Code starts with T14. SN Code Name CA EE TM Type Credit Min% Semester 01: 24 Credits, Foundation Courses 01 T14011 Basic Science 20 80 100 T 4 50% 02 T14012 Basic Mathematics 20 80 100 T 4 50% 03 T14013 Technical Communication 20 80 100 T 4 50% 04 T14014 Engineering Mechanics 20 80 100 T 4 50% 05 T14015 TC, PP and Soft-Skills 20 80 100 TW 4 50% 06 T14016 Computer Basics and Basic Science 20 80 100 P 4 50% Semester 02: 24 Credits, Foundation Courses 07 T14021 Applied Science 20 80 100 T 4 50% 08 T14022 Applied Mathematics - 1 20 80 100 T 4 50% 09 T14023 Electronic Components & Applications 20 80 100 T 4 50% 10 T14024 Engineering Drawing-2 20 80 100 T 4 50% 11 T14025 Workshop Practice (Programme Specific) 20 80 100 TW 4 50% 12 T14026 Applied Science and Engineering Drawing – 1 20 80 100 P 4 50% Semester 03: 24 Credits, Basic Courses 13 T14031 Basic Electronics 20 80 100 T 4 50% 14 T14032 Applied Mathematics - 2 20 80 100 T 4 50% 15 T14033 Basic Electrical Engineering 20 80 100 T 4 50% 16 T14034 Electrical and Electronic Measurement 20 80 100 T 4 50% 17 T14035 Computer Programming 20 80 100 TW 4 50% 18 T14036 Basic Electronics, Electrical and Measurement 20 80 100 P 4 50% Semester 04: 24 Credits, Basic Courses 19 T14041 Industrial Instrumentation 20 80 100 T 4 50% 20 T14042 Transformers and DC Machines 20 80 100 T 4 50% 21 T14043 AC Machines 20 80 100 T 4 50% 22 T14044 Electrical Power Generation 20 80 100 T 4 50% 23 T14045 Industrial Instrumentation and Basic Mechanical Engineering 20 80 100 TW 4 50% 24 T14046 Transformers , DC and AC Machines 20 80 100 P 4 50% Semester 05: 24 Credits, Core Courses 25 T14051 Industry Electrical Systems 20 80 100 T 4 50% 26 T14052 Microcontroller 20 80 100 T 4 50% 27 T14053 Power Electronics 20 80 100 T 4 50% 28 T14054 Electrical Power Transmission and Distribution 20 80 100 T 4 50% 29 T14055 20 80 100 TW 4 50% 30 T14056 Industry Electrical Systems and Energy Conservation & Audit Microcontroller and Power Electronics 20 80 100 P 4 50% Semester 06: 24 Credits, Advance Courses 31 T14061 Industrial Management 20 80 100 T 4 50% 32 T14062 Switchgear & Protection 20 80 100 T 4 50% 33 T14063 Electrical Testing and Maintenance 20 80 100 T 4 50% 20 80 100 T 4 50% T14064 T15064 Elective-I : Any one of following courses Illumination Engineering Modern Electric Traction 35 T14065 Project-Work 20 80 100 PW 4 50% 36 T14066 Electrical Testing and Maintenance and Activity Course on Elective 1 20 80 100 P 4 50% 34 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 8 EVALUATION PATTERN SN Type of Course 1 Theory (T) Continuous Assessment 1. 2. 3. 4. 2 Practical End Examination Student is required to answer 1 of 1 SAQ, each of 5 marks, on each Credit Single attempt only Marks: 20 Marks Duration: Specified 1 Month 1. Student is required to answer 4 out of 5 SAQ, each of 5 marks, on each Credit Maximum 5 EE attempt during each semester till last end exam, if specified Marks: 80 Marks Duration: 150 minutes 2. 3. 4. SN Description Evaluation of End Examination Marks 1 Question Type 4 out of 5 Short Answer Question (SAQ) for each Credit 20 Marks each Credit 2 Total 16 out of 20 Short Answer Question (SAQ) 80 Marks 1. 2. 3. 4. Student is required to submit “Activity Report in 1. Work-Book Format” for each Credit in the prescribed format. Single Attempt only Marks: 20 Marks Duration: Specified 1 Month External and internal examiners shall assess each student based on: a. Continuous Assessment submission by the student (Only by External Examiner) [20 Marks] b. Practical Activity performed by the student [40 Marks] c. Viva on Practical Activities [20 Marks] Maximum 5 Attempts only Marks: 80 Marks Duration: 180 minutes 2. 3. 4. SN 3 Term Work (TW) Internal Examiner External Examiner 1 Workbook, Diagram, synoptic Answers, Graph/Observation and Conclusion - 20 Marks 2 Actual Conduct of Practical 20 Marks 20 Marks 3 Viva/Oral 10 Marks 10 Marks 4 Total 30 Marks 50 Marks 1. 2. 3. 4. SN 4 Project Work (PW) Evaluation of Practical End Examination Description Student is required to submit “Activity Report in Work-Book Format” for each Credit in the prescribed format. Single Attempt only Marks: 20 Marks Duration: Specified 1 Month 1. 2. 3. 4. External and internal examiners shall assess each student based on: a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by External Examiner) [20 Marks] b. Viva on Activity Report [60 Marks] Maximum 5 Attempts only Marks: 80 Marks Duration: 180 minutes Evaluation of Project Work End Examination Description Internal Examiner External Examiner 1 Workbook submission - 20 Marks 2 Viva/Oral 30 Marks 30 Marks 3 Total 30 Marks 5. 6. 7. 8. Student is required to submit “Activity Report in Project Report Format” for each Credit in the prescribed format. Single Attempt only Marks: 20 Marks Duration: Specified 1 Month 50 Marks 5. 6. 7. 8. SN External and internal examiners shall assess each student based on: a. Project Report submission by the student (Only by External Examiner) [20 Marks] b. Project Presentation by the student [30 Marks] c. Viva on Project Report[30 Marks] Maximum 5 Attempts only Marks: 80 Marks Duration: 180 minutes Evaluation of Project Work End Examination Description Internal Examiner External Examiner 1 Project Report - 20 Marks 2 Presentation 15 Marks 15 Marks 3 Viva/Oral 15 Marks 15 Marks 4 Total 30 Marks 50 Marks Actual CA and EE marks shall be used in computation of “Total Marks (TM)”. Only best of the past performance shall be reported. Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 9 SEMESTER 01 T14011: BASIC SCIENCE PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 03. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 01 V55 T14011 Basic Science 4 45 120 100 TH Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Part I: Basic Physics Apply Basic Facts, Concepts, Principles and Techniques of Scientific Investigation of Physical Quantities and Processes which are used in Technology Part II: Basic Chemistry Comprehend the mechanism of electrolysis Explain properties of metals, non- metals & alloys related to engineering applications Use metallic and non-metallic materials in engineering applications UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Part I : Basic Physics 01 02 03 04 Elasticity Surface Tension Viscosity Transmission of Heat and Expansion of Solids Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 05 06 07 Gas laws and Specific Heats of Gases Sound Properties of Light Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Part II : Basic Chemistry 08 09 Atomic Structure Electrochemistry Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 10 11 Metals and Alloys Non-Metallic Materials Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 10 UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Credit Block Part I : Basic Physics 01 Elasticity: Introduction, Elasticity, Plasticity and Plastic Body, Molecular Theory of Elasticity, Stress, Strain and Their Types, Elastic Limit and Hooke’s Law, Types of Modulus Elasticity, Behavior of Wire Under Continuously Increasing Load, Factor of Safety 02 Surface Tension: Introduction- Molecular Force, Cohesive Force, Adhesive Force, Laplace’s Molecular Theory of Surface Tension, Angle of Contact and its Significance, Capillarity or Capillary Action, Shape of Liquid surface in a Capillary Tube, Surface Tension of Liquid in a Capillary Tube, Effect of Impurity and Temperature on Surface Tension of Liquid 03 Viscosity: Introduction, Fluid Friction, Viscous Force, Viscosity, Newton’s Law of Viscosity, Flow of Liquid through a Tube – Streamline Flow and Turbulent Flow, Significance of Reynolds’s number, Free Fall of Spherical Body Through Viscous Medium and Stokes Law, Up Thrust force, Terminal Velocity, Stokes Law 04 Transmission of Heat and Expansion of Solids: Three Modes of Transmission of Heat, Conduction in detail, Thermal Conductivity and Coefficient of Thermal Conductivity, Expansion of Solids-Definition of linear, aerial and cubical expansion and relation between them 05 Gas laws and Specific Heats of Gases: Introduction, Gas Laws, General Gas Equation and Specific and Universal Gas Constant, Standard or Normal Temperature and Pressure, Concept of Absolute Zero and Absolute Scale of Temperature, Two Specific Heats of Gas and Relation between them, Isothermal and Adiabatic Changes of Gas 06 Properties of Light: Properties of Light- Reflection, Refraction, Dispersion, Polarization, Diffraction, Principle of Superposition of Waves, Interference, Constructive Interference and Destructive Interference, Conditions for Stationary Interference Pattern Credit Optical fibre: principle, structure of optical fiber, propagation of light wave through optical fibre, derivation of numerical aperture and 02 acceptance angle 07 Sound: Concept of Wave Motion, Relation Between Velocity, Frequency and Wavelength, Transverse Wave and its Characteristics, Longitudinal Wave and its Characteristics, Equation of Progressive Wave, Stationary Waves or Standing Waves, Node and Antinode, Forced and Free Oscillations, Resonance, Formula for Velocity of Sound with End Correction Credit 01 Part II : Basic Chemistry 01 Atomic Structure: Introduction, Particles of Matter, Dalton’s Atomic Theory, Size of an Atom, Thomson’s Atomic Model, Rutherford’s Scattering Experiment, Drawbacks of Rutherford’s Atomic Model, Bohr’s Atomic Model, Modern Atom, Composition of an Atom, Rules of Distribution of Electrons in Shells, Energy Levels and sub energy Levels, Atomic Orbitals, Quantum Numbers, Pauli’s Exclusion Principle, Hund’s Rule and Aufbau’s Principle, Electronic Configuration of Atoms, Electronic Configuration of Inert Gas Elements, Isotopes, Isobars, Electronic Theory of Valency, Lewis and Langmuir Concept of Stable Configuration, Concept of Variable Valency, Types of Valency, Electrovalency, Formation of Electrovalent Compounds, Covalency, Formation of Covalent Compounds, Distinction between Electrovalent and Covalent Compounds 02 Electrochemistry: Introduction, Atom and Ions, Ionisation and Electrolytic Dissociation, Arrhenius Theory of Electrolytic Dissociation, Degree of Ionisation, Significance of the Terms Involved in Electrolysis- Such as Conductors, Insulators, Dielectrics, Electrolyte, NonElectrolyte, Electrolysis, Electrolytic Cell, Electrodes. Electrode Potential and Concept of Electrode Potential such as Reduction Potential and Oxidation Potential, Mechanism of Electrolysis – Primary & Secondary Reactions at Cathode and Anode, Electrochemical Series for Cations and Anions, Electrolysis of CuSo4 Solution by using Cu Electrode & Platinum Electrode, Electrolysis of NaCl Solution and Fused NaCl by using Carbon Electrode, Faraday’s Laws of Electrolysis and Numericals, Applications of Electrolysis such as Electroplating and Electro Refining, Electrometallurgy and Electrotyping, Conductivity of Electrolyte, Electrochemical Cells and Batteries- Definition, Types such as Primary and Secondary Cells and Their Examples. - Construction, Working and Applications of i) Dry Cell ii) Lead-Acid Storage Cell 03 Metals and Alloys: Metals: Introduction, Characteristics of Metal- Mechanical Properties of metals such as Hardness, Toughness, Ductility, Malleability, Tensile Strength, Machinability, Weldability, Forging, Soldering, Castability. Metalloids, Occurrence of Metals- Mineral, Ore. Metallurgy, Gangue, Flux and Slag, Stages of Extraction of Metals from its Ores in detail-Crushing, Concentration, Reduction, and Refining. Physical Properties and Applications of some commonly used metals such as Fe, Cu, Al, Cr, Ni, Sn, Pb, Zn, Co, Ag, W. Alloys: Definition of Alloy, Preparation Methods, Purposes of Making alloy, Classification of Alloys such as Ferrous and Non Ferrous and their examples. Composition, Properties and Applications of Alnico, Duralumin, Dutch Metal, German, Silver / Nickel Silver, Gun Metal, Monel Metal, Wood’s Metal, Babbitt metal 04 Non Metallic Materials: Credit i) Plastics: What are Plastics?, Polymerisation, Formation of Plastic by Addition and Condensation Polymerisation by giving e.g. of 04 Polyethylene and Backelite plastic Respectively, Structure of Plastics, Types of Plastic- Thermosoftening and Thermosetting Plastic with Definition and Distinction, Compounding of Plastics- Resins, Fillers, Plasticizers, Acceleraters, Pigments and their examples, Properties of Plastic, Engineering Applications of Plastic ii) Rubber: Rubber, Natural Rubber and Its Processing, Drawbacks of Natural Rubber, Vulcanisation of Rubber with Chemical Reaction, Synthetic Rubber- Definition, Distinction Between Natural and Rubber. Properties of Synthetic Rubber such as Elasticity, Tack, Abrasion Resistant, Stress and Strain, Application of Rubber iii) Thermal Insulating Materials: Thermal Insulating Materials, Factors Affecting Thermal Conductivity of Insulators, Characteristics of Good Insulating Materials, Classification of Thermal insulators, Preparation, Properties and Applications - Glass wool, Thermocole, Asbestos and Cork Credit 03 LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 11 University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14011-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14011-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Part I : Basic Physics Physics –I Tata McGraw-Hill T14011 –RB1 V. Rajendran Engineering Physics S. Chand Publishers – New Delhi T14011 –RB2 B.L. Theraja Engineering Physics Dhanpat Rai Publication, T14011 –RB3 R.K.Gaur and S.L.Gupta New Delhi T14011 –RB4 Physics- Std XI, Std XII Physics- Std XI, Std XII Part II : Basic Chemistry Engineering Chemistry, Dhanpat Rai and Sons T14011-RB5 Jain & Jain Engineering Chemistry, S. Chand Publication T14011–RB6 S. S. Dara, Industrial Chemistry, 1st 2002 Goel Publication T14011 –RB7 B. K. Sharma, 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14011 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14011-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 12 T14012: BASIC MATHEMATICS PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 03. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14012 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Basic Mathematics Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Apply basic facts, concepts, principles and procedures of mathematics as a tool to analyze engineering problems UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 03 Logarithms Partial Fraction Vectors Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 04 05 Determinants and Matrices Binomial Theorem Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 06 07 08 09 10 Trigonometric Ratios Trigonometric Ratios of Allied, Compound, Multiple & Submultiple Angles Factorization and De-factorization Formulae Inverse Trigonometric Ratios Properties of Triangles Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 11 12 13 Point and Distances Straight Line Circle Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Credit Block 01 Logarithms: Definition of Logarithm (Natural And Common Logarithm) and Examples based on it, Laws of Logarithm and Examples Based on it 02 Partial Fraction: Definition of Proper and Improper Fractions, Definition of Partial Fractions, To Resolve Proper Fraction into Partial Fraction with Denominator Containing – i) Non Repeated Linear Factors ii) Repeated Linear Factors iii) Non Repeated Irreducible Quadratic Credit Factors, To Resolve Improper Fraction Into Partial Fraction –i) Numerator and Denominator are of the Same Degree Ii) Numerator is of a 01 Degree Higher than that of Denominator 03 Vectors: Definition of Vector, Position Vector, Algebra of Vectors (Equality, Addition, Subtraction and Scalar Multiplication), Dot (Scalar) Product with Properties, Vector (Cross) Product with Properties, Applications of Vectors- Work Done and Moment of Force about a Point and Line Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 13 04 Determinant and Matrices: Determinant- Definition and Expansion of Determinants of 2nd and 3rd Order, Cramer’s Rule to Solve Simultaneous Equations in 2 and 3 Unknowns Matrices- Definition of a Matrix of Order m by n, Types of Matrices, Algebra of Matrices Such As Equality, Addition, Subtraction, Scalar Multiplication and Multiplication of Two Matrices, Transpose of a Matrix, Minor, Cofactor of an Element of a Matrix, Adjoint of Matrix and Credit 02 Inverse of Matrix By Adjoint Method, Solution Of Simultaneous Equations Containing 2 and 3 Unknowns by Matrix Inversion Method 05 Binomial Theorem : Definition of Factorial Notation, Definition of Permutation and Combinations with Formula, Binomial Theorem for Positive Index, General Term, Binomial Theorem for Negative Index, Approximate Values (Only Formula)-Surds, Progressions 06 07 Trigonometric Ratios: Trigonometric Ratios of Any Angle, Ratios of Special Angles 00, 300, 450, 600, Quadrantal Angles, Relation Between Degree and Radian, Fundamental Identities, Examples Based on Fundamental Identities Credit 03 Trigonometric Ratios of Allied, Compound, Multiple and Submultiple Angles: Examples based on Allied, Compound, Multiple and Submultiple Angles (particularly for allied angles- numerical must be done by calculators). 08 Factorization and De-factorization Formulae: Examples based on Factorization and De-factorization Formulae 09 Inverse Trigonometric Ratios: Definition of inverse trigonometric ratios, Principal values of inverse trigonometric ratios, Relation between inverse trigonometric ratios 10 Properties of Triangles: Sine, Cosine, Projection and Tangent Rules, Simple problems based on it 11 Point and Distances: Distance Formula, Section Formula, Midpoint, Centriod of Triangle, Area of Triangle and Condition of Collinearity 12 Straight Line: Slope And Intercept of Straight Line, Equation of Straight Line in i) Slope Point Form ii) Slope-Intercept Form, iii) Two-Point Credit Form iv) Two-Intercept Form v) Normal Form vi) General Equation of Line, Angle Between Two Straight Lines Condition of Parallel and 04 Perpendicular Lines, Intersection of Two Lines, Length of Perpendicular from a Point on the Line and Perpendicular Distance Between Parallel Lines 13 Circle: Equation of Circle in i) Standard Form ii) Centre – Radius Form iii) Diameter Form iv)Two–Intercept Form, General Equation of Circle, Its Centre and Radius, Equation of Tangent and Normal to a Circle LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14012-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14012-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Applied Mathematics Second 2010- C. Jamnadas & Co. T14012 -RB1 G.V. Kumbhojkar 11 Mathematics for Polytechnic First Pune Vidyarthi Griha Prakashan, T14012 -RB2 S. P. Deshpande Aug 2005 Trigonometry S. Chand Publication T14012 -RB3 S. L. Loney Higher Algebra Metric edition, Book T14012 -RB4 H. S. Hall & S. R. Palace, New Delhi Knight Matrices Schuam series, McGraw hill T14012 -RB5 Ayres Engineering Mathematics 40th Edition 81-7409-195-5 T14012 -RB6 Grewal B.S. 2009 Khanna Publishers 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14012 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14012-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 14 T14013: TECHNICAL COMMUNICATION PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 03. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14013 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Technical Communication Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand and use the basic concepts of communication and principles of effective communication in professional field Effectively communicate about any technical matter Enhance writing skills required for the various types of letters, reports and office drafting UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 Introduction to Communication Types of Communication Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 03 04 Principles of Effective Communication Non Verbal- Graphic Communication-1 Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 05 06 Non Verbal- Graphic Communication-2 Written Communictaion-1 Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Written Communictaion-2 Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 07 DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 02 Credit Block Introduction to communication: Introduction, Need of Communication, Importance of Communication, Significance of Communication, Definition of Communication, Communication Cycle, Elements of Communication, Stages in the Communication Process - Defining the Context, Knowing the Audience, Designing the Message, Encoding, Selecting Proper Channels, Transmitting, Receiving, Decoding and Giving Feedback Credit Types of Communication: Introduction, Types of Communication- i) According to Application : Internal-External, ii) According to the 01 Nature of Communication: Formal- Informal, iii) According to Direction: Vertical- horizontal diagonal iv) According to Mode of Communication: Verbal-Nonverbal Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 15 03 04 05 06 07 Principles of Effective Communication: Introduction, Principles of Effective Communication, Communication Barriers and their Overcomes- Physical, Mechanical, Psychological and Semantic, Developing Effective Messages-Thinking about Purpose, Knowing the Audience, Structuring the Message, Selecting Proper Channels, Minimizing Barriers and Facilitating Feedback Credit Non Verbal- Graphic Communication-1: Introduction- The Development of Non Verbal Codes, The importance of Non Verbal 02 Communication, Non-Verbal Codes: Kinesecs, Proxemics, Haptics, Vocalics, Physical Appearance, Chronemics, Artifacts Non Verbal- Graphic Communication-2: Aspects of Body Language, Graphical Communication- Aspects of Graphical Communication, Charts and Graphs, Organizational Charts, Flow Charts, Block Charts, Pie Charts, Graphs, Bar Graphs, Rectilinear Graphs, Multiple Lines Graph, Semi-Log Graph, Tables Credit Written Communictaion-1: Letter Writing, Inquiry Letter, Reply to the Letters of Inquiry, Order letter, Complaint 03 letter, and Adjustment letter, Circular, Notices, and Memorandum Written Communictaion-2: Application Letter with Resume, Report Writing, Minutes of the Meeting, Interviews, Defining and Describing Credit Objects and Giving Instructions 04 LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14013-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14013-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Developing Communication Skills, Macmillan T14013 -RB1 Krushna Mohan, Meera Banerji, Communication Skills, Reliable Series T14013 –RB2 Joyeeta Bhattacharya Every Ones Guide to Effective Writing, Apple publishing T14013 –RB3 Jayakaran 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14013 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14013-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 16 T14014: ENGINEERING MECHANICS PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 02. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14014 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Engineering Mechanics Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Explain various concepts, principles techniques and procedures used in machines and measuring instruments Describe the Method of Resolution Calculate the resultant of given force system, the reactions of beam, friction, centroid and the center of gravity Define Ideal Machine and state importance of law of machine Describe various simple machines used in engineering structures UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Fundamental Concepts Resolution and Composition of Forces Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 03 Equilibrium Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 04 05 Friction Centroid Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 06 07 Center of Gravity Simple Machines Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Credit Block Fundamental Concepts: Introduction-Necessity of Engineering Mechanics, Definition of Statics, Dynamics, Kinematics, Kinetics, Rigid Credit Body, Elastic Body; Definition of Mass and Weight, Difference in Between Mass and Weight; Scalars and Vectors; Units of Measurement01 System of Unit, Basic S. I. Unit of Physical Quantity like Length, Mass and Time, Derived S. I. Units of Some of the Physical Quantities. Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 17 02 Resolution and Composition of Forces: Force- Definition, S.I. Unit of Force, Unit Newton Force of Unit Force or one Newton Force, Representation of a Force by Vector Method, Characteristics of a Force or Properties of a Force; Effects of Force; System of ForcesCoplanar Forces or Coplanar Force System; Resultant Force (R), Equilibrant Force, Difference between Resultant and Equilibrant Force; Composition of Forces; Law of Parallelogram of Forces; Principle of Transmissibility of a Force or Law of Transmissibility of Forces; Problems based on Analytical Method of Law of Parallelogram of Forces for Coplanar Concurrent Force System; Analytical Method by Resolution of Force or Method of Resolution - Definition, Types of Component of a Force - Perpendicular Component and NonPerpendicular Component, Resolution of Forces or Method of Resolution- When The Force is always from the Point With Respective Quadrants, When the Force is towards the Point with Respective Quadrants, How to Determine Resultant (R) of Coplanar Concurrent Force System; In Magnitude and Direction; Problems on Coplanar Concurrent Forces by Method of Resolution (Analytical Method); Resolution of Force “F” In Two Direction, not Perpendicular with each other; Resultant of Coplanar Collinear Forces; Graphical Method; Graphical Representation of a Force; Bow’s Notation and Representation of a Force By Bow’s Notation; Space Diagram; Vector Diagram; Triangle Law of Forces; Polygon Law of Forces; How To Find Resultant (R) in Magnitudes and Direction Graphically In Case of Coplanar Concurrent Forces; Problems on Coplanar Concurrent Forces By Graphical Method; Important Concepts- Moment of Force, Geometrical Representation of Moment of a Force and its S.I. Unit, Classification of Moments according to Direction of Rotation, Sign Convention, Law of Moments, Varignon’s Theorem of Moments and it’s Use; Couple- Definition, S.I. Unit, Characteristic of a Couple or Properties of a Couple, Measurement of a Couple, Properties of Couple, How to Find Resultant Force (R) of Coplanar Non- Concurrent Forces System, In Magnitude, Direction and Position by Analytical Method, Problems on Coplanar Non- Concurrent Forces System by Analytical Method; Resultant on Coplanar Non- Concurrent Forces System by Graphical Method- Polar Diagram, Funicular Polygon; Problems on Coplanar Non- Concurrent Forces System by Graphical Method 03 Equilibrium: Definition, Relation Between Resultant Forces and Equilibrant Force, Conditions of Equilibrium- Analytical and Graphical Condition of Equilibrium for Concurrent, Parallel Force System, Non- Concurrent on- Parallel Force System, Free Body and free Body Diagram; Lami’s Theorem- Statement and Explanation, Proof or Derivation, Application of Lami’s Theorem for solving Various Engineering Problems having Two unknowns only, Limitations for applying Lami’s Theorem; Free Body Diagram (FBD): Significance of FBD, Problems on Lami’s Theorem; Equilibrant- Definition, Relation Between Resultant and Equilibrant , Equilibrant of Concurrent and Non- Concurrent Force System, Problems on Coplanar Concurrent Forces (More Than Three) Acting on a Body in Equilibrium; Graphical Method- Graphical Condition of Equilibrium, Problems on Coplanar Concurrent Forces Acting on Body in Equilibrium by Graphical Method; Beam- Definition, Span of Beam, Types of Beam - Cantilever, Simply Supported, Overhanging, Fixed, Continuous; Types of End Support – Simple Support, Hinged, Roller, Fixed; Classification of Loads- Pont Load, Inclined Point Load, Uniformly Distributed Load; Reactions of a Simply Supported and Overhanging Beam by Analytical and Graphical Method; Problems on Simply Supported Beam by Analytical Method; Examples on Overhang Beam, Hinged and Roller Supported Beam; Problems on Hinged and Roller Supported Beam; Problems on Beam by Graphical Method; Problems on Hinged and Roller Supported Beam by Graphical Method 04 05 Credit 02 Friction: Introduction-Definition of Friction; Advantage and Disadvantage of Friction; Types of Friction; Definition- Limiting Frictional Force and Coefficient of Friction (); Angle of Friction ()- Relation between Angle of Friction() and Coefficient of Friction (); Definition of Cone Friction and its Properties; Laws of Friction- Static, Kinetic or Dynamic; Factors on which Force or Frictional Resistance Depends; Credit Angle of Response (α); Problems on a Rough Horizontal Plane and Inclined Plane; Ladder Friction- Problems on Ladder Friction 03 Centroid: Introduction- Definition of Centroid, Moment of an Area about an Axis, Centroid of Basic Geometrical Figures such as Square, Rectangle, Triangle, Circle, Semicircle and Quarter Circle, Different Sections, Composite Figures, Centroid of Composite Figures, Procedure of Finding the Centroid, Problems on Centroid 06 Centre of Gravity: Definition; Centre of Gravity (G) for Composite Body, Centre of Gravity (G) of Simple Solids Such as Cylinder, Spheres, Hemisphere, Cone, Cube and Regular Block, Centre of Gravity (G) of Some Geometrical Solid Body; Center of Gravity (G) of Composite Solids (Hollow Solids shall be Considered); Procedure of Finding the Centre of Gravity, Problems on Centre of Gravity; Frustum of Cone; 07 Simple Machines: Definition of Simple Machine or Lifting Machine and Compound Machine; Definition of - Effort (P), Load (W), Velocity Ratio(V.R.), Mechanical Advantage (M. A.), Input of a Machine, Output of a Machine, Efficiency (η) of a Machine, Actual Machine, an Ideal Credit Machine, Ideal Effort (Pi), Ideal Load (Wi), Lever Arm; Law of Machine; Maximum Mechanical Advantage ( Max M.A.) and Maximum 04 Efficiency (Maximum η) of Machine; Definition- Reversibility of Machine, Irreversible Machine or Non- Reversible Machine or Self- Locking Machine, Condition for Reversibility of a Machine (no Deviation) and Self- Locking Machine; Graphs; Study of Simple Machines- Simple Wheel and Axle, Differential Axel and Wheel, a Simple Screw Jack, Weston’s Differential Pulley Block, Worm and Worm Wheel, Single Gear Crab or Single Purchase Winch Block, Double Gear Crab or Double Purchase Winch Crab, Geared Pulley Block, Pulley Blocks, Two Sheave and Three Sheave Pulley Block; Problems on Machines LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14014-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14014-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Engineering Mechanics, Tata McGraw Hill, Delhi T14014 –RB1 Basu Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 18 Engineering Mechanics, Beer – Johnson Fundamental of Applied Mechanics, T14014 –RB3 Dhade, Jamdar & Walawalkar Applied Mechanics, T14014 –RB4 R. S. Khurmi Engineering Mechanics, T14014 –RB5 Shames and Rao 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14014 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14014-WL1 T14014 –RB2 Tata McGraw Hill, Delhi Pune Vidhyarthi Gruh Prakashion, Pune Dhanpat Rai & sons, Delhi Pearson Education Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 19 T14015: TC, PP AND SOFT-SKILLS PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 03. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14015 Course Name TC, PP and Soft-Skills Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 120 120 100 TW Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘2 online SCORM lectures’ at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘2 face-to-face lectures (each of 45 minutes duration) at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each Term-Work or Practical session shall be of 240 minutes duration. Remaining time of 195 minutes after initial lectures of 45 minutes shall be used for actual conduct and reporting of Term-work/practical activities during each session. 4. Two session per week, each of 240 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: In total evaluation, Internal Examiner (IE) and External Examiner (EE) shall have 50% weightage. Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA) (Only by IE): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by EE): 20 Marks b. Viva on Term-Work Submission by the student: 30 Marks (by EE) + 30 Marks (by IE) PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Develop reading and listening skills Enhance writing skills required for the various types of letters, reports and office drafting Express or communication effectively Apply techniques of effective time management and appropriate body language Develop good habits to overcome stress Obtain information from different sources, organize collected information and share with peers Prepare a report on industrial visit/ expert lecture Participate in the team work activities DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Soft Skills: Introduction, What are Soft Skills, Importance of Soft Skills, Selling Your Soft Skills, Attributes Regarded as Soft Skills, Soft Skills: Social Soft Skills: Thinking Soft skills: Negotiating, Exhibiting Your Soft Skills, Identifying Your Soft Skills, Improving Your Soft Skills, Will Formal Training Enhance Your Soft Skills, Soft Skills Training, Train Yourself, Top 60 Soft Skills, Practicing Soft Skills, Measuring Attitude, Exercise: Measure Your Soft Skills. 02 Know Thyself / Self-Discovery: Introduction, Importance of Knowing Yourself, Process of Knowing Yourself, SWOT Analysis, Benefits of SWOT Analysis, Using SWOT Analysis, SWOT Analysis Grid, Questions to Complete the Grid, Exercise : Know Yourself 03 04 05 Credit Block Developing Positive Attitude: Introduction, Meaning, Features of Attitudes, Attitude and Behavior, Formation of Attitudes, Change of Attitudes, What Can You do to Change Attitude?, Ways of Changing Attitude in a Person, Attitude in a Workplace, The Power of Positive Attitude, Developing Positive Attitude, Obstacles in Developing Positive Attitude, Staying Positive, Examples of positive attitude, Positive Attitude and its Results, Staying Negative, Examples of Negative Attitude, Overcoming Negative Attitude, Negative Attitude and its Results. Credit Exercise: Measure your Attitude. 01 Forming Values: Introduction, Meaning, What is a Value?, A Core of Values, Values Relating to Education, Values Relating to Self and Others, Values Relating to Civic Responsibilities, Values and Attitudes, Importance of Values, Formation of Values, Types of Values, Terminal and Instrumental Values, Power of Values, Personal Values, Cultural Values, Social Values, Values-some Examples. Exercise: Identify Your Values. Improving Perception: Introduction, Meaning, Factors influencing Perception, Perceptual Process, Improving Perception, Perception and its Application in Organizations, Exercise: Test your perception. Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 20 06 07 Career Planning: Introduction, Benefits of Career Planning, Guidelines for Choosing a Career, Myths about Choosing a Career, Tips for Successful Career Planning, Developing Career Goals, Final Thoughts on Career Planning, Things One Should Know While Starting Career and During his Career, Exercise: Test Your Career Interests. Art of Listening: Introduction, What is Listening?, Two Ears-one Mouth, Benefits of Active Listening, Kinds of Listening, Factors that Hamper Listening, Common poor Listening Habits, Advantages of Active Listening, Listening Tips. 08 Art of Reading: Introduction, Reading is a Cognitive Process, Good Readers are what they Read, Benefits of Reading, Different types of Reading, Tips for Effective Reading, The SQ3R Technique, Different Stages of Reading, Rates of Reading, Determining a Student's Reading Rate, Adjusting Reading Rate, Activities for Increasing Reading Rate, Problems With Reading, Becoming an Effective Reader, Exercise: Test Your Reading Skills. 09 Art of Speaking: Introduction, What Makes Communication Important?, Defining Communication, Special Features of Communication, Credit 02 Communication Process, Channels of Communication, Formal Communication Network, Informal Communication Network (Grapevine Communication), Importance of Communication, Barriers to Communication, Tips for Effective Communication, Conversation Tips, What is Presentation?, Tips for Powerful Presentation, Art of Public Speaking, Importance of Public Speaking, Benefits of Public Speaking, Public Speaking Tips, Over Coming Fear of Public Speaking. 10 Art of Writing: Introduction, Importance of writing, Creative Writing, Writing Tips, Drawbacks of Written Communication, Exercise : Test your handwriting 11 Art of Writing E-mail: Introduction: The Mail Magic, Use Appropriate Salutations, Make the Subject Matter Significant, Keep a Dictionary Close By, Use Commas-Use Smileys, When In Doubt, Preface, Include Previous Message, Shorten the file Attachments, Reread Before Pressing The "Send" Button, Be Polite and Reciprocate Good Deeds, Anticipate, Empathize, Understand, What Netiquette? 12 Body Language: Introduction, Body Talk, Voluntary and Involuntary Body Language, Forms of Body Language, Parts of Body Language, Origin of Body Language, Uses of Body Language, Body Language in Building Interpersonal Relations, Body Language in Building Industrial Relations, Reasons to Study Body Language, Improving your Body Language, Types of Body Language, Gender Differences, Female Interest and Body Language, Shaking Hands with Women, Interpreting Body Language, Developing Confidence with Correct Body Language. 13 Team Building and Teamwork: Introduction, Meaning, Aspects of Team Building, Skills Needed for Teamwork, A Model of Team Building, Team Vs Group, Characteristics of Effective Team, Role of a Team Leader, Role of Team Members, Nine Persons a Successful Team Should have, Inter-Group Collaboration, Advantages of Inter-Group Collaboration, Difficulties faced in Inter-Group Collaboration, Factors Shaping Inter-Group Collaboration, Exercise : Test Your Teamwork Skills 14 Group Discussion: Introduction, Meaning of GD, Why Group Discussion?, Characters Tested in a GD, Tips on GD, Types of GD, Skills Credit Required in a GD, Consequences of GD, Behaviour In A GD, Essential Elements of GD, Different Characters in GD, Traits Tested in a GD, GD 03 Etiquette, Areas to be Concentrated while preparing for a GD, Initiating a GD, Techniques to initiate a GD, Non-Verbal Communication in GD, Movement and Gestures to be avoided in a GD, Topics for GD 15 Etiquette and Manners: Etiquette : Introduction, Modern Etiquette, Benefits of Etiquette, Classification of Etiquette, Accompanying Women, Taboo Topics, Proposing the Toast; Manners: Introduction, Poor Manners Noticed in Youth, Why Should you Practice Good Manners?, Practicing good Manners, Manners at the Wheel: Driving, Manners in The Flight, Respecting The Sacred: Visiting Holy Places, Dealing with the Challenged, Attending Funeral, Professional Manners, Social Skills (Manners), Getting along With People, Manners to get respect from others, To sum up, Corporate Grooming Tips, Mind Your Mobile Manners, Annoying Office Habits. Exercise 1 : Test Your Etiquette, Exercise 2 : Test Your Manners 16 Preparing CV / Resume: Introduction, Meaning, Difference Among Bio-Data, CV and Resume, The terms, The Purpose of CV Writing, Types of Resumes, Interesting facts about Resume, CV Writing Tips, CV/Resume Preparation- the Dos, CV/Resume Preparation- the Don'ts, Resume Checkup, Design of a CV, Entry Level Resume, The Content of the Resume, Electronic Resume Tips, References, Power Words, Common Resume Blunders, Key Skills that can be Mentioned in the Resume, Cover Letters -Cover Letter Tips. 17 Interview Skills: Introduction, Why an Interview?, Types of Interview, Interview Panel, Types of Questions Asked, Reasons for Selecting a Candidate, Reasons for Rejecting a Candidate, On the day of Interview, On to the Interview Table, Attending Job fair, Common Mistakes that you wouldn't want to do, Questions the Candidate should not ask during the Interview, Post-Interview Etiquette, How does one Follow Up?, Telephonic Interview, Dress Code at Interview, Typical Questions asked, Interview Mistakes, Quick Tips- How to Present well in Interview, Tips to Make a Good Impression in an Interview, Job Interview-Basic Tips, How to Search for Job Effectively, Interview Quotations. 18 Time Management: Introduction, The 80:20 Rule, Take a Good Look at the People around you, Examine your Work, Sense of Time Management, Time is Money, Features of Time, Three Secrets of Time Management, Time Management Matrix , Analysis of Time Matrix, Effective Scheduling, Grouping of Activities, Five Steps to Successful Time Management, Difficulties in Time Management, Evils of Not Planning, Time Management is a Myth, Overcoming Procrastination Ways to Find Free Time, Time Management Tips for Students, Interesting Facts about Time, Ideal Way of Spending a Day, Time Wasters, Time Savers, Realizing the Value of Time, Time Circle Planner. Exercise : Test Your Time Management Skills 19 Stress Management: Introduction, Meaning, At one Level Stress May be a Positive Aid to Performance, At one Level Stress may be a Negative Aid To Performance, Effects of Stress, Kinds of Stress, Sources of Stress, Few other Common Sources of Stress, Case Study, Behaviour Identified with Stress, Assessing The Existence of Stress, What Are the Signs of Stress?, Spotting Stress in you, Stress Management Tips Teenage Stress, Make the Mornings Memorable, Exercise: Do You Have Same Stress-Prone Habits? Credit 04 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity Credit Block Questions Course Content Covered under ‘Detail Syllabus of Required Theory of T14015: TC, PP and SoftStudents have to submit Credit 01 Skills’ Course. Based on course content following assignments are suggested which is to be ‘Activity Report in Work-Book completed in the work-book or Journal Format’ in CA and Perform Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 21 01 Chapter 1: Measure your soft- skills Chapter 2: Analyze yourself with respect to your strength and weaknesses, opportunities and threats 02 (SWOT analysis) on the basis of the following points: i) Your past experiences, ii) Achievements, iii)Failures, and iv)Feedback from others etc 03 Chapter 6 : Test your career interest 04 Chapter 13: Explore your teamwork skills ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Chapter 14: Discuss a topic in a group and prepare minutes of discussion. Write a report of the topic discussed 06 Chapter 15 : Test your Etiquettes and manners 07 Chapter 18: Explore your Time Management skills 08 Chapter 19: Explore your stress prone habits 05 Deliver a seminar on the any one topic form your own discipline for 10-12 minutes using 09 presentation aids (Time for presentation 10 min. per student) and submit seminar report of at least 10 pages. Credit 02 10 Conduct an interview of a personality and make a report for the same. 11 Industry Visit of own discipline to nearby factory/ small scale unit/center be arranged and individual student has to submit a report on it. 12 Industry Expert Lecture / Lecture by Professionals on latest topic of own discipline be arranged and individual student has to submit a report on it Collect and submit a report on Techno-commercial information on any topic of own discipline by an 13 individual student (Sources of data collection may be Technical Journals, Internet, Magazines, Product catalogues, Exhibition & Surveys etc) 14 Credit 03 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Course Content Covered in T14013: Technical Communication Course. Based on course content following assignments are suggested which is to be completed in the work-book or Journal 15 Communication Cycle (With The Help of Diagram) Barriers that obstruct a Particular Communication Situation. (State the type of barrier, 16 and how to overcome them) 17 18 19 20 21 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 04 Developing a Story or a Paragraph for the given Topic Sentence (in a group of 5- 6 students) Describing Various Equipment’s Write a Business Letters Write a Letters of Suggestion Report Writing Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Title Author Edition Year ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14015-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14015-TB1 Soft Skills Dr K Alex 2nd Revised Ed 2011 81-219-3192-4 S Chand & Company Ltd 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! 2nd Revised Ed 2011 T14015 -RB1 Soft Skills Dr K Alex 81-219-3192-4 S Chand & Company Ltd T14015 –RB2 Developing Communication Skills Krushna Mohan, Meera Banerji Macmillan T14015 –RB3 Presentation Skills Michael Hatton ( Canada – India Project) ISTE New Delhi T14015 –RB4 Time management Chakravarty, Ajanta Rupa and Company T14015–RB5 Stress Management Through Yoga and Meditation Sterling Publisher Pvt Ltd 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14015 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 22 T14015-WL1 http://www.mindtools.com http://www.thomasarmstrong.com/multiple_intelligences.php http://www.coopcomm.org/workbook.htm http://www.quickmba.com/strategy/swot/ http://managementhelp.org/ http://www.ethics.com Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 23 T14016: COMPUTER BASICS AND BASIC SCIENCE PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 03. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14016 Course Name Computer Basics and Basic Science Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 120 120 100 P Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘2 online SCORM lectures’ at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘2 face-to-face lectures (each of 45 minutes duration) at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each Term-Work or Practical session shall be of 240 minutes duration. Remaining time of 195 minutes after initial lectures of 45 minutes shall be used for actual conduct and reporting of Term-work/practical activities during each session. Evaluation Pattern: In total evaluation, Internal Examiner (IE) and External Examiner (EE) shall have 50% weightage. Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 2. Continuous Assessment (CA) (Only by IE): 20 Marks 3. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by EE): 20 Marks b. Actual Conduct of Practical by the student: 20 Marks (by EE) + 20 Marks (by IE) c. Viva on Practical Report/Activity: 10 Marks (by EE) + 10 Marks (by IE) PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES PART I: COMPUTER BASICS Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand fundamentals of computer system with various hardware and software components Use basic features of Windows 7 Use basic features of MS Word 2010, MS Excel2010 and MS Power Point 2010 Use basic features of Windows Live Essentials, emails and Internet DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Fundamentals of Computer: Various Types of Computers: Personal Computer, Personal Digital Assistant, Laptop Computer, Tablet PC with Stylus, Mainframe Computer, Supercomputer ; Computer Hardware : Keyboard, Mouse , Monitor, Printer, Speakers ,Scanner; System Unit : Front Side of the System Unit, Backside of the System Unit, Inside the System Unit; Other Hardware Devices, Computer Software: System Software, Application Software Introducing Window 7: Exploring New and Improved Features of Windows 7: The Getting Started Menu, HomeGroup, Jump List ; Aero Peek, Aero Snap, and Aero Shake, Windows Search, Windows Taskbar, Desktop Gadget Gallery , Performance Improvements, Play To, Ribbon, Remote Media Streaming, Windows Touch, Libraries , Internet Explorer 8, Action Centre, Windows Live Essentials, Device Management, Exploring Windows 7 Editions, Installing Windows 7: System Requirements, Fresh Installation, Window7 Upgrade Advisor, Upgrade from Previous Versions of Windows, Windows Update, Starting Windows 7, Getting Help in Windows 7, Logging Off, Restarting, and Shutting 01 Down a System Exploring the Windows 7 User Interface: Exploring the Desktop, Working with Desktop Icons, Changing the Properties of the Desktop, Working with Desktop Gadgets. Using the Taskbar, Customizing the Taskbar, Managing an Opened Window, Customizing the Notification Area, Using the Start Menu, Starting a Program , Pinning a Program to the Start Menu, Customizing the Start Menu Working with Windows Explorer: Exploring the Windows Explorer Interface: Address Bar, Search Box, Toolbar ,Navigation Pane, Content Pane , Detail Pane, Preview Pane, Menu Bar, Working with Libraries: Exploring Libraries, Creating a New Library; Performing Basic File and Folder Operations: Creating Files and Folders, Renaming Files and Folders, Opening and Viewing the Content of Folders, Copying and Moving Files and Folders, Deleting Files or Folders; Performing Advanced File and Folder Operations: Compressing Files and Folders, Setting File Properties, Searching Files and Folders, Burning Files to a CD or DVD; Working with Recycle Bin: Permanently Deleting Items from Recycle Bin, Recovering Items from Recycle Bin Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit Block Credit 01 Page 24 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 Working with Internet Explorer and Windows Live Essentials: Working with Internet Explorer: Opening Internet Explorer , Accessing a Web Site, Tabbed Browsing of Web Pages, Printing a Web Page , Managing Favorites , Exploring History, Changing the Home Page, Enabling and Disabling Pop‐Ups, Phishing Filter. Using Windows Live Essentials: Downloading and Installing Windows, Live Essentials, Working with Windows Live Messenger, Working with Windows Live Family Safety, Working with Social Sites Introducing Microsoft Word 2010: Exploring New Features of Microsoft Word 2010, Starting Microsoft Word 2010 , Exploring the User Interface of MS Word 2010, Exploring the Common Features of MS; Word application: Mini toolbar, Live preview , Contextual Tab, Key Tips ,Screen Tips; Exploring Tabs in Ribbon: Home Tab, Insert Tab, Page Layout Tab, References Tab, Mailings Tab, Review Tab, View Tab; Saving the Document: Saving a Document in Compatible Format , Saving Document as a PDF File; Creating a New Document : Creating a Blank Document , Creating a Document based on a Template , Opening an Existing Document ,Closing the Document; Quitting from Microsoft Word 2010 Working with First Document in MS Word 2010: Preparing the First Document: Setting the Page Margins, Changing the Page Size, Changing the Page Orientation; Working with Text : Adding Text in a Document, Editing Text , Creating Bulleted and Numbered Lists ; Applying Text Formatting: Changing Font and Font Size of Text, Applying Bold, Italic, and Underline , Applying Strikethrough, Subscript and Superscript , Changing the Color of Text, Copying and Clearing Formatting; Applying Paragraph Formatting : Setting Indent for Paragraph, Adding a Paragraph Border ; Changing the Page Background : Applying a Background Color , Adding Built‐In Watermark , Creating and Applying Custom Watermark ; Adding a Page Border, Inserting Header and Footer, Changing the Document Views ; Printing the Document : Previewing a Document , Setting Print Options Proofreading a Document: Proofreading a Document, Performing Spelling and Grammar Checks, Using the Thesaurus, Using the word Count Feature, working with the AutoCorrect Option, Restricting Editing in a Document, Inserting and Removing Comments, Reviewing a Document, Tracking Changes, Accepting and Rejecting Changes Working with Pictures and Tables: Working with Graphical Object : Inserting a Picture, Inserting Clip Art , Inserting a Shape, Inserting a SmartArt Graphic , Inserting a WordArt , Performing Advance Operation on Graphical Object : Cropping a Picture, Adding a Border to a Picture, Removing the Background of a Picture , Changing the Brightness or Contrast of a Picture, Setting Height and Width of a Graphical Object , Grouping Objects , Wrapping Text ; Working with Table: Inserting a Table, Adding Rows and Columns in an Existing Table, Changing Rows Height and Columns Width , Merging and Splitting Cells, Splitting a Table, Changing Cell Margins and Cell Spacing , Inserting a Formula , Adding Borders and Shadings Introduction to Excel 2010: Exploring New and Enhanced Features of Excel 2010, Understanding Workbooks and Worksheets, Starting Microsoft Excel 2010, Exploring the Microsoft Excel 2010 User Interface : The File Tab , Quick Access Toolbar , The Title Bar, The Minimize, Maximize/Restore, and Close Buttons ,The Ribbon , The Formula Bar, The Name box , The Worksheet ,Scroll Bars ,The Sheet Tab ,The Status Bar; Exploring the Ribbon : Customizing the Ribbon, Exploring the Excel Options Dialog Box ; Working with Templates: Creating a Workbook by using a Template ,Customizing a Template, Closing a Workbook and Quitting Microsoft Excel 2010, Application Working with Worksheets and Cells: Exploring the Different Types of Data used in Excel: Entering Data in a Worksheet, Saving a Workbook , Opening an Existing Workbook, Managing Worksheets in a Workbook :Adding a New Worksheet, Renaming a Worksheet, Deleting a Credit Worksheet ; Working with Rows and Columns: Inserting Rows and Columns , Deleting Rows and Columns, Describing the Cut, Copy, and 02 Paste Commands : Using the Cut Command ,Using the Copy Command , Using the Paste Command; Formatting Cells : Adjusting the Row and Column of Cells, Working with Fonts , Working with Text Alignment ; Formatting a Worksheet : Setting the Margins in a Worksheet , Inserting Headers and Footers in a Worksheet, Editing a Header and Footer, Printing a Worksheet Working with Charts, Smart Art graphics, and Sparklines: Understanding Charts : Understanding Chart Type , Working with Charts, Working with Chart Options; Working with Smart Art Graphics: Inserting SmartArt graphics in a Worksheet , Adding Text to a SmartArt graphic , Selecting a Style for a SmartArt Graphic; Understanding Sparklines , Working with Sparklines : Creating Sparklines, Changing the Type and Colour of Sparklines, Highlighting Data Points , Deleting Sparklines Working with Formulas and Functions: Exploring the Basic Concepts used in Formulas: Understanding Operators in Formulas,Understanding Operator Precedence , Understanding Cell Referencing; Exploring the Basic Concepts used in Function: Explaining the Function Syntax, Correcting Errors in a Function; Working with Mathematical and Statistical Functions: Using the Product Function , Using the SUM Function, Using the ROUND Function ,Using the AVERAGE Function ; Working with Text Functions: Using the CONCATENATE Function , Using the LEN Function, Using the FIND Function ; Working with Logical Functions : Using the AND Function, Using the IF Function, Using the OR Function ; Working with Financial Functions :Using the PV Function, Using the NPV Function , Using the FV Function, Using the PMT Function, Using the NPER Function ,Using the RATE Function Introducing Microsoft PowerPoint 2010: Exploring Microsoft PowerPoint 2010 Features , Launching Microsoft PowerPoint 2010 , Exploring Microsoft PowerPoint 2010 Interface : Quick Access Toolbar, Title Bar, Minimize, Maximize, and Close Buttons, File Tab, Ribbon, Dialog Box Launcher, Scroll Bar ,Working Area , Slides and Outline Tabs , Slide Pane , Notes Pane, Status Bar, Navigation Pane , Zoom Control ; Exploring the Tabs: The Home Tab, The Insert Tab, The Design Tab, The Transitions Tab,The Animations Tab , The Slide Show Tab, The Review Tab, The View Tab; Creating a Presentation in Different Ways: Creating a Presentation using the Blank Template , Creating a Presentation using an Installed Template, Inserting a New Slide ; Saving a Presentation: Saving Presentation in the Default File Format Saving Presentation as PDF, Getting Help on PowerPoint , Closing the Presentation and Quitting PowerPoint; Exploring PowerPoint Options : General Tab , Proofing Tab, Save Tab ,Language Tab , Advanced Tab, Customize Ribbon Tab, Quick Access Toolbar Tab, Add‐Ins Tab, Trust Centre Tab Working with a Presentation: Opening an Existing Presentation, Working with Text: Adding Text Using a Placeholder ,Adding Text Using a Text Box, Adding Current Date and Time , Adding Slide Number, Formatting the Text ,Creating a Bulleted List ; Moving and Deleting Slides: Moving a Slide, Deleting a Slide ; Working with Themes: Adding Themes, Setting a New Font for the Theme , Setting a Theme as a Default Theme Inserting Objects in a Presentation: Adding Charts to a Slide, Working with Clip Arts: Inserting a Clip Art, Modifying a Clip Art ; Working with Images : Inserting an Image, Cropping an Image, Inserting a Shape , Inserting WordArt ; Working with Smart Art Graphics: Inserting a SmartArt Graphic, Converting Text into SmartArt Graphic ; Working with Tables: Inserting a Table , Adding Text in a Table, Deleting a Table; Adding Videos and Sound Clip: Adding a Video, Adding a Sound Clip Enhancing the Presentation: Working with the Transition Effects: Adding a Transition Style ,Adding a Transition Sound, Setting Time Duration of a Slide, Applying the Transition Effect to all Slides, Applying Effects on a Transition; Working with Animation: Adding Animation to an Object , Applying Effects to an Animated Object, Reordering Animation; Creating a Photo Album, Printing a Presentation Sharing a Presentation :Sending a Presentation as an E‐mail, Saving a Presentation on the Web; Converting a Presentation in a Video Format ,Packaging Your Presentation on a CD DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 25 Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity [Perform Any 14 Activities) 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 Credit Block A. Fundamentals of Computer: Study various types of computers and review the parts of computer B. Introducing Window 7: Install windows 7 and explore new features of windows 7 Working with Windows Explorer Navigating folders and their contents Staying organized with your own folders Choosing how your folders and user interface behave Sharing and protecting folders and files Simplifying organization with libraries Backing up by burning to CD or DVD Exploring the Windows 7 User Interface Getting familiar with the desktop Handling tasks with the improved task bar Accessing your favorites quickly with jump lists Finding files and programs with Windows Search Using the Action Center Keeping information at your fingertips with desktop gadgets Working with Internet Explorer: Opening Internet Explorer Accessing a Web Site Tabbed Browsing of Web Pages Printing a Web Page Managing Favorites Exploring History Phishing Filter Working with Windows Live Essentials: Setting up your Windows Live profile Downloading Windows Live Essentials Tracking dates and events with the Windows Live calendar Free email with Windows Live Mail Texting live with Windows Live Messenger Organizing and sharing photos in Photo Gallery Controlling content and communications with Family Safety Introducing Microsoft Word 2010: Word Backstage: From "New" to "Print" Managing documents with Backstage view Creating a new document from a template Making it easy to find and open documents Saving a Word document for yourself or others Printing a document and choosing a printer Setting print options Working with First Document in MS Word 2010: A. Editing Text Selecting text using the mouse and keyboard shortcuts Rearranging text using Cut, Copy, and Paste Undoing and redoing actions Finding and replacing text B. Formatting Text Understanding fonts Working with fonts Applying basic formatting Changing the case of text Using text effects and adding impact to a document C. Formatting Paragraphs Aligning and justifying paragraphs Changing line spacing Using indents and setting tabs Creating a bulleted or numbered list Keeping text together through page breaks Applying shading and borders to paragraphs Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 01 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 26 08 09 10 11 12 Working with First Document in MS Word 2010: A. Modifying Page Layout Setting page margins, page orientation, and paper size Inserting sections to organize a document Using columns Using watermarks, page borders, and colors Proofreading a Document: B. Proofing Documents Checking spelling and grammar Setting proofing and AutoCorrect options Using the Thesaurus and Research and Translation tools Working with Pictures and Tables: A. Illustrating a Document Illustrating documents with pictures, shapes, and clip art Positioning, sizing, and cropping graphics Wrapping text around graphics Laying out text and graphics with a table Adjusting brightness, contrast, and sharpness of photos Applying special effects to graphics Applying styles to graphics Illustrating with charts: Inserting a chart from Excel Illustrating with diagrams: Using SmartArt Illustrating with screenshots: Capturing screenshots from your computer Illustrating with WordArt B. Working with Tables Creating a table to organize text Converting text to tables Formatting tables for readability Adding and removing columns Sorting table data Merging, splitting, and formatting cells to create a form Converting a table to text Inserting an Excel table for calculations and charts Using Quick Tables Working with Worksheets and Cells: Worksheet Basics Creating a worksheet Techniques for copying and pasting Entering data automatically with Auto Fill Targeting large data groups Changing a worksheet's structure Working with Formulas and Functions: Excel Formula Basics Understanding formulas and functions Entering data in a worksheet Adding numbers manually Adding numbers using Sum and AutoSum Adding a whole worksheet Working with numbers in columns Preventing errors using absolute references Working with times and dates Using IF Using SUMIF and AVERAGEIF Naming and using cell ranges Working with Worksheets and Cells: Essential Formatting Formatting numbers and dates Applying fonts, background colors, and borders Adjusting columns, rows, and text Using conditional formatting Using custom conditional formatting Adding pictures and shapes Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 02 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 27 13 14 15 16 Working with Charts, Smart Art graphics, and Sparklines: Creating and Using Charts Choosing chart types Inserting Sparklines Creating a column chart Modifying a column chart Creating and modifying a pie chart Placing Excel charts into other Office applications Introducing Microsoft PowerPoint 2010: Adding slides and content Deleting slides and changing layouts Rearranging slides Saving time with Outline mode Separating your show into sections Adding photos and clip art Spell-checking Using the thesaurus Saving a presentation Applying a theme Running the show Working with a Presentation: Formatting a Presentation Using fonts and color Adding bullets and list numbering Changing text alignment Using picture effects Removing backgrounds from photos Understanding slide masters Changing slide backgrounds Adding a logo to the background Applying slide transitions Saving the design template Inserting Objects in a Presentation: A. Adding Tables and Charts Creating tables Formatting tables Pasting tables from Excel Creating charts Pasting charts from Excel B. Adding Audio and Video Adding an audio clip Adding video Cropping video C. Adding SmartArt and Diagrams Adding organizational charts Adding cycle diagrams, Venn diagrams, and other diagrams LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Title Author Edition Year ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14016-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14016-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Information Technology for Management Henry Lucas Tata Mc-Graw Hills T14016 -RB1 T14016–RB2 Computer Fundamentals Architecture and New Age International Publisher Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 28 Organisation B.Ram 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T04016 -CD1 1st Reprint 2002 Comdex Computer Course Kit Vikas Gupta Dreamtech, New Delhi 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T04016-WL1 PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES PART II: BASIC SCIENCE Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Basic Physics Verify the principles, laws, using given instruments under different conditions Interpret the results from observations and calculations Basic Chemistry Analyze the various solutions used in chemical Laboratory Interpret the results by observing Chemical Reactions DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY Credit Block UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Course Content Covered in T14011: Basic Science (Part I: Basic Physics course) Credit 01 02 Course Content Covered in T14011: Basic Science (Part II: Basic Chemistry course) Credit 02 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity Credit Block Perform any seven (7) activities from T14011: Basic Science (Part I: Basic Physics course) Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units 01 To use Vernier Caliper for the measurement of dimensions of given object. 02 Questions To use Micrometer Screw Gauge for the measurement of dimensions (Length, Thickness, Diameter) of given object. 03 To calculate Young’s modulus of elasticity of metal (e.g. steel) wire. 04 To study capillarity phenomenon and to verify that the height of liquid in capillary is inversely proportional to the radius of capillary. 05 To determine coefficient of viscosity of given liquid or fluid (Glycerin) using Stoke’s Method. 06 To calculate the Linear Thermal coefficient of expansion for copper by using Pullinger’s apparatus. Credit 01 07 Determine the coefficient of thermal conductivity of copper by Searle’s method. 08 To Verify Boyle’s law and to find out atmospheric pressure in the laboratory using graph. 09 To determine the velocity of sound by using resonance tube. 10 Determine stiffness constant ‘K’ of a helical spring. 11 Determine refractive index of liquid by concave mirror. Perform any seven (7) activities from T14011: Basic Science (Part II: Basic Chemistry course) Perform qualitative analysis of five Solutions, Containing One Basic and One Acidic Radical as Listed 01- below +2 +2 +3 +2 +3 +3 +2 +2 +2 +2 +2 + 4+ Credit 02 05 Basic Radicals: Pb , Cu , Al , Fe , Fe , Cr , Zn , Ni , Ca , Ba ,Mg , K , NH - -2 -2 Acidic Radicals: Cl , Br , I , CO3 , SO4 , NO3 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units 06 To Determine electrochemical equivalent of Cu by Using CuSO4 Solution & Copper Electrode 07 To Determine the % of Fe in the Given Ferrous Alloy by KMnO4 Method. Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 29 Determine pH value of given solutions by using pH paper, universal indicator and pH Meter. 09 To Prepare Phenol Formaldehyde Resin (Backelite). 08 LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T04016-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T04016-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Part I : Basic Physics Engineering Physics Tata McGraw-Hill T14011 –RB1 V. Rajendran Engineering Physics S. Chand Publishers – New Delhi T14011 –RB2 B.L. Theraja Engineering Physics Dhanpat Rai Publication, T14011 –RB3 R.K.Gaur and S.L.Gupta New Delhi T14011 –RB4 Physics- Std XI, Std XII Physics- Std XI, Std XII Part II : Basic Chemistry Engineering Chemistry, Dhanpat Rai and Sons T14011-RB5 Jain & Jain Engineering Chemistry, S. Chand Publication T14011–RB6 S. S. Dara, Industrial Chemistry, 1st 2002 Goel Publication T14011 –RB7 B. K. Sharma, 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14016 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14016-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 30 SEMESTER 02 T14021: APPLIED SCIENCE PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 03. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14021 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Applied Science Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Part I: Applied Physics Understand aspects of kinematics, kinetics, ultrasonic, acoustics, indoor lighting Basic principles of probing medium used for N.D.T. Concept used in Nano-technology Part II: Applied Chemistry Understand use of metals & non- metallic materials in engineering field Analyze Protect Metallic & Non Metallic Surfaces Apply the knowledge to select lubricants as per application Special Note: Theory paper will have two parts one for Applied Physics and one for Applied Chemistry. Each will have equal weightage of 50 marks (CA 10 Marks and End Exam 40 Marks). UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Part I : Applied Physics 01 02 03 04 Rectilinear Motion Angular Motion Kinetics Ultrasonic Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 05 06 07 08 Non-Destructive Testing of Materials Acoustics Indoor Lighting Introduction of Nano Technology Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Part II : Applied Chemistry 09 10 11 Electrochemistry Non Metallic Engineering Material Lubricant Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 31 12 13 Metals and Alloys Corrosion Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Credit Block Part I : Applied Physics 01 Rectilinear Motion: Introduction; Important Definitions: Kinematics, Rectilinear Motion, Displacement, Distance, Velocity, Uniform Velocity, Average Velocity, Speed, Acceleration, Uniform Acceleration, Uniform Acceleration; Kinematics Equation of Motion with Uniform Acceleration or Equation of Rectilinear Motion with Uniform Motion: (i)Equation of Motion when Velocity of a Body Moving with Uniform Acceleration after Time ‘t’, (ii)Equation of Motion when Distance (s) Travelled by a Body Moving with Uniform Velocity, (iii)Equation of Motion when Velocity of a Body Moving with Uniform Acceleration after covering a Distance ‘s’, (iv) Equation of Motion when Distance travelled in nth Second by Particle (or Body) Moving with Uniform Acceleration, from these (i),(ii),(iii),(iv) Equations we get four Kinematics Equations of Motion or Equations of Rectilinear Motion with Uniform Acceleration; V-T Diagram; Equations of Rectilinear Motion under Gravity; Problems on Equation of rectilinear Motion; Problems on Equation of Rectilinear Motion under Gravity; Problems on V-T Diagram 02 Angular Motion: Introduction; Definitions of Important Terms: Angular Motion or Circular Motion, Angular Displacement(θ), Angular Velocity (ω), Uniform Angular Velocity, Angular Acceleration (α), Uniform Angular Acceleration; Equations of Angular Motion with Constant Angular Acceleration; Analogy between Equations of Circular Motion and Equation of Rectilinear Motion; Relation between Rectilinear Motion and Angular Motion; Simple Harmonic Motion (S.H.M.); S.H.M. as projections of Circular Motion; Definitions related to S.H.M.; Graphical representation of S.H.M., Graphical representation of Displacement, Velocity, and Acceleration of particle in S.H.M; Examples of Angular Motion; Examples on Relation between Rectilinear Motion and Circular Motion; Problems on S.H.M. 03 Kinetics: Introduction; Important Definitions: Mass, Momentum, Velocity, Speed, Acceleration, Impact, Impulse or Impulse Force, Impulsive Force (F); Newton’s Laws of Motion: Newton’s First Law of Motion, Newton’s Second Law of Motion, Newton’s Third Law of Motion; Law of Conservation of Momentum: Recoil of Gun, Recoil Velocity; Equation of Motion with Uniform Linear Accelerations: Equation of Motion under Gravity; Problems on Momentum and Impulse; Problems on Newton’s Laws of Motion; Problems on the Law of Conservation of Momentum; Motion Lift; Motion of two bodies of weight W1 and W2 connected by a string or rope passing over a Frictionless Pulley; Problems on Motion of Lift (Elevator or Cage); Problems on Two Connected Bodies by an Inextensible String or rope Passing Over a Frictionless Pulley 04 Ultrasonic: Ultrasonic Waves: Application, Definition: Ultrasonic Waves, Definition: Infrasonic Waves, Range; Production of Ultrasonic Waves; Magnetostriction Effect; Magnetostriction Method; Piezo-Electric Effect; Piezo-Electric Method; Properties of Ultrasonic Waves; Application of Ultrasonic Waves. 05 Non-Destructive Testing of Materials: Introduction to NDT (Non Destructive Testing); Destructive Testing; Non Destructive Testing: Advantages of NDT, Limitations of NDT, Names of NDT Methods used in Industries, Factors for Selection of NDT; Liquid Penetration Method (Dyepenetrant Test): Principle, Procedure, General Interpretation of results, Liquid Penetrants, Advantages, Limitations, Applications; Magnetic Particle Method (Magnaflux): Principle, Procedure, Advantages, Limitations, Applications, Characteristics of MPT and Factors for Selection; Ultrasonic Testing: Principle, Ultrasonic Test Method, Procedure, Advantages, Limitations, Applications, Precautions 06 07 08 Credit 01 Acoustics: Introduction; Frequency of Sound and Limits of Audibility; Pitch/ Loudness/Timbre; Intensity of Sound; Reflection of Sound; Coefficient of Absorption(a); Transmission Coefficient (t); Reflection Coefficient (r); Weber and Fetcher’s Law: Intensity Level, Threshold of Audacity, Threshold of Pain; Echo; Reverberation; Reverberation Time; Sabine’s Formula for Reverberation Time; Conditions for Good Acoustics; Noise pollution and its Prevention; Factors which affect the Acoustical planning of Auditorium and its Remedy, Remedies to Credit Reduce the Effect of External Noise; Sound Insulation; Solved Problems 02 Indoor Lighting: Introduction; Important Definitions; Inverse Square Law of Illumination; Illuminance of Obligate Incidence; Principle of Photometry (Equations of Photometry); Bunsen’s Photometer: Working, Applications; Indoor Lighting: Need, Lighting Schemes, Factors Affecting the Indoor Lighting, Advantages of Illumination or Lighting System; Solved Problems Introduction to Nano Technology: Introduction; Nanomaterials: Manufacture/Preparation of Nanomaterials; Graphite; Fullerene; Quantum Dots and Quantum Wells; Carbon Nanotubes (CNT’s); Properties of Carbon Nanotubes; Application of Carbon Nanotubes; Nanowires; Nanocones; Haeckelites; Applications of Nanomaterials: Medical, Applications in Environmental Technology, Applications in Electronics; General Applications Part II : Applied Chemistry 09 Electrochemistry: Conductivity of Electrolytes: Ohm’s law, Specific Conductivity or Conductance (k), Equivalent Conductivity (λv), Molar Conductivity (λm), Measurement of Conductance, Cell Constant, Variation of Specific Conductance with Dilution, Variation of Equivalent Conductance with Dilution; Concept of pH and pOH; Buffer Solutions: Acidic Buffers - Acidic Buffer can be made from Acetic Acid and Sodium Acetate, Basic Buffers – Basic Buffer can be prepared from Ammonium Hydroxide and Ammonium Chloride; Application of pH in Engineering 10 Non-Metallic Engineering Materials: Engineering Plastic and Rubbers: Polyvinyl Chloride (PVC), Polystrene (PS), Bakelite (Phenolplasts or Credit 03 phenolic Resins), Kevlar, Epoxy resins (Polyethers), Polycarbonates (PC), Polyurethanes, Teflon (Polytetrafluroethylene, PTFE) or Fluon, Thermocole, Reclaimed Rubber, Reinforced Plastics or Filled Plastics, Polyvinyl Acetate (Poly Acetals), Silicones; Ceramics: Classification on basis of Application, General properties of Ceramics, Basic Raw Materials; Porcelain; Refractories: Classification, Properties, Applications; Composite Materials: Types of Composites, Advantageous Characteristics of Composite 11 Lubricants: Introduction; Classification: Solid Lubricants, Semi- solid Lubricants, Liquid Lubricants or Lubricating Oils; Lubrication: Fluid Film or Thick Film or Hydrodynamic Lubrication, Boundary Lubrication or Thin-Film Lubrication, Extreme-Pressure Lubrication; Function of Lubrication; Selection of Lubrication; Characteristics of Lubricants: Physical Properties, Chemical Properties Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 32 12 13 Metals and Alloys: Metallurgy: Crushing, Concentration (or Dressing of the Ore); Ores of Iron: Oxides, Carbonate Ores, Sulphides; Indian Resources of Iron; Manufacture of Pig Iron (Extraction of Iron): Working of Blast Furnace, Operation of Blast Furnace; Products of the Blast Furnace; Commercial Forms of Iron: Pig Iron or Cast Iron, Wrought Iron, Steel; Types of Castings; Heat Treatment: Hardening or Quenching, Tempering, Annealing (Softening), Normalizing; Ferrous Alloys: Steels, Alloys of Steels, Purpose of Alloying Steels, Effects of Alloying Elements on Properties of Steel, Classification of Alloy Steels; Non-Ferrous Alloys: Copper Alloys, Aluminium Alloys (or LightCredit Weight Alloys), Bearing Alloys, Solders, Nickel Alloys, Low Melting Alloys 04 Corrosion: Introduction; Types of Corrosion: Atmospheric Corrosion, Factors Affecting Atmospheric Corrosion, Immersed Corrosion (or Electrochemical Corrosion), Mechanism of Electrochemical Corrosion; Protection of Metals from Corrosion: Purification of Metal, Alloy Formation, Cathodic Protection (Making Metal Cathode), Controlling External Conditions, Application of Protective Coatings; Method of Applying Metallic Coating: Hot Dipping, Metal Spraying, Cementation or Diffusion Coatings, Metal Cladding, Electroplating; Non-corrosive Material; Organic Coating: Paints, Lacquers, Enamels, Emulsions Paints, Special Paints LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14021-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14021-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Physics –I Tata McGraw-Hill T14021 –RB1 V. Rajendran Applied physics Tata McGraw-Hill T14021 –RB2 Arthur Beiser Engineering Physics Dhanpat Rai Publication, T14021 –RB3 R.K.Gaur and S.L.Gupta New Delhi Fundamentals of Physics 8th Edition Wiley India Pvt. Ltd T14021 –RB4 Resnick, Halliday & Walker Nano technology- principles and practices Capital publishing company T14021 –RB5 Dr. S K Kulkarni Engineering Chemistry, Dhanpat Rai and Sons T14021 –RB6 Jain & Jain Engineering Chemistry, S. Chand Publication T14021 –RB7 S. S. Dara, Environmental Chemistry & Pollution Control, S. Chand Publication T14021 –RB8 S. S. Dara, Polytechnic Chemistry, Jain brothers T14021 –RB9 Vedprakash Mehta, Industrial Chemistry, 1st Goel Publication T14021 –RB10 B. K. Sharma, 2002 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14021 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14021-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 33 T14022: APPLIED MATHEMATICS -1 PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 03. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14022 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Applied Mathematics-1 Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Apply basic facts, concepts, principles and procedures of mathematics as a tool to analyze engineering problems UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Functions Limits Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 03 Derivatives Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 04 05 06 Applications of Derivatives Measures of Central Tendency Graphical Representation Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 07 08 Measures of Dispersion Complex numbers Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Credit Block 01 Functions: Introduction, Definitions of Variable, Constant, Intervals such as Open, Closed, Semi-Open etc., Definition of Function, Value of a Function, Range and Domain of a Function, Types of Functions, Illustrative Examples 02 Limits: Introduction, Concept of Limit, Theorems of Limits, Types of Limits- Algebraic, Trigonometric, Exponential, Logarithmic, Illustrative Examples 03 Derivatives: Concept of Derivative, Definition of Derivative, Different Notations for Derivative, First Principle Method of Finding Derivative of a Function, List of Derivatives of Standard Functions, Rules of Derivatives- Sum or Difference, Product, Quotient, Composite Functions, Credit List of Derivatives of Composite Function at a Glance, Derivatives of Exponential Functions, Derivatives of Logarithmic Functions, 02 Derivatives of Inverse Functions, Derivatives of Implicit Functions, Logarithmic Differentiation, Derivative of Parametric Functions, Derivative of One Functions with respective to Another Functions, Higher Order Derivatives, Illustrative Examples Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit 01 Page 34 04 05 Application of Derivatives: Introduction, Geometrical Meaning of Derivative(Slope, Gradient), Equations of a Tangent and a Normal to the given Curve, Maxima and Minima, Radius of Curvature, Illustrative Examples Credit 03 Measures of Central Tendency: Introduction, Mean, Median and Mode for raw, ungrouped and grouped Data/frequency distribution, Illustrative Examples 06 Graphical Representation: Introduction, Histogram Construction when Class Intervals are Equal and Unequal, Cumulative Frequency Curve or Ogive Curves to find Median, Illustrative Examples 07 Measures of Dispersion: Introduction, The Range, Mean Deviation, Standard Deviation, Variance, Coefficient of Standard Deviation, Coefficient of Variance, Illustrative Examples 08 Complex Number: Introduction, Definition of Complex Number, Powers of i and Properties of i, Algebra of Complex number- Conjugate, Credit Equality, addition, Subtraction, Multiplication and Division, Graphical representation of a Complex Number (Argand’s Diagram)- Modulus 04 of Complex Number, Amplitude of Complex Number, Different Forms of a Complex Number, De-Moivre’s Theorem (without proof) Examples based on it, Root of Complex Numbers, Circular Functions of Complex Number, Hyperbolic Functions, Relations between Circular and Hyperbolic Functions LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14022-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14022-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Mathematics for Polytechnic First Pune Vidyarthi Griha Prakashan, T14022 -RB1 S. P. Deshpande Aug 2005 Calculus :Single Variable Tata McGraw Hill T14022 –RB2 Robert T Smith Advanced Engineering Mathematics S. Chand Publication, New Delhi T14022 –RB3 Dass H. K. Fundamentals of Mathematical Statistics S. Chand Publications New Delhi T14022 –RB4 S.C Gupta and Kapoor Higher Engineering Mathematics, 40th Edition 81-7409-195-5 T14022 –RB5 Dr B S Grewal, 2009 Khanna Publishers 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14022 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14022-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 35 T14023: ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS & APPLICATIONS PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V62: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14023 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Electronic Components & Applications Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand the construction, working principle of the various electronics component Draw Layout of the electronics Circuits, Designing and testing of the PCB Understand importance of Surface mount technology Identify and select electronic components as per specified applications UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 Resistors Capacitors Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 03 04 05 06 Inductors Cables Connectors Relays Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 07 08 09 Switches Displays Integrated Circuits (IC) Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 10 11 Surface Mount Devices (SMD) Printed Circuit Board (PCB) Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Resistors: Factors affecting resistance, classification of resistors, Linear and Non-Linear Resistors, Equivalent circuit of resistor, Materials used for resistors, Specifications of resistors, Resistance color coding, Classification of Resistors: 1. Fixed Resistors: Carbon Composition Resistors, Carbon Film Resistors, Wire Wound Resistors 2. Variable Resistors: a. Linear: Potentiometers - Logarithmic and Linear, Trimmer, Rheostat b. Non-Linear: Light Dependent Resistors (LDR), Temperature Dependent Resistors (TDR) Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit Block Credit 01 Page 36 02 03 04 Capacitors: classification of capacitors, Materials used for capacitors, Dielectric Materials, Specifications of capacitors, capacitor color coding, Equivalent circuit of capacitors, Classification of capacitors: 1. Fixed capacitors: Non-Electrolytic capacitors, Disc Ceramic capacitors, Paper capacitors, Mica capacitors, Plastic Film capacitors, Glass Capacitors, Electrolytic capacitors, Aluminum Electrolytic capacitors, Tantalum Electrolytic capacitors 2. Variable Capacitors: Requirements, Air-Gang capacitors, PVC Gang capacitors, Trimmer capacitors Inductors: Different Magnetic Materials, Hysteresis, Soft and hard Magnetic Materials and its comparison, Magnetic Material Losses, Hysteresis Losses, Eddy Current Losses, Iron Losses, Faraday’s Law of Electromagnetic induction, Induced EMF, Specifications of Inductors, Shielding of Inductors, Testing of Inductors, Inductor color coding, Classification of Inductors: 1. Fixed Inductors: Air core Inductors, Iron core inductors, Ferrite Core inductors, comparison of these types 2. Variable Inductors: Slug tuned inductors, Tapped inductors 3. Frequency Range Inductors: AF Chokes, RF Chokes, IF Chokes, Toroidal Inductors Credit 02 Cables: Characteristics, Types, High and low impedance cable, Ribbon cable, High Temperature Cable, Flat Twin Cable, RF Cable, Telephone Cable, FRC Cable, Optical Fiber Cable, Measurement of test parameters, Carious test on coaxial cables 05 Connectors: Specifications, Types of connectors - Audio, Phone Plug and Jacks, RF, Video, Printer, RH-45, Edge, FRC 06 Relays: Characteristics, Types of Relays - Electromagnetic , Reed, Mercury wetted , Comparisons among various types 07 Switches: Specifications, Types of switches - Toggle, Rotary, Rocker, Slide, Push button, Thumb Wheel 08 09 Displays: LED, Bicolor LED, LCD, LED / LCD comparison , Seven Segment Displays, Common Anode Displays, Common Cathode Displays, 16 Segment Display, 14 Segment Display, Dot Matrix Array, Passive Display, Dynamic Scattering Display, Field Effect Displays Credit 03 Integrated Circuits (IC): Advantages and disadvantages of ICs, IC Applications, IC Classification – Analog ICs, Digital ICs, Monolithic ICs, Thin and Thick Film ICs, Hybrid ICs. Comparison among various types of ICs, IC package types and its testing 10 Surface Mount Devices (SMD): Surface mount technology and fabrication, Advantages and disadvantages of SMDs, Types of SMDs – Resistors, Ceramic Capacitors, Tantalum capacitors, Active components, SOT, SOICs, PLCC, SOJ, DFP, SQFP, BGA, Land Pattern of SMDs, Applications of SMDs 11 Printed Circuit Board (PCB): Types of PCBs, Base and conducting materials, types and properties of laminates, Single side PCB. 1. PCB Layout – Artwork, Artwork materials, Film Master Production, Reprographic Cameras, Film processing, Artwork check and inspection. Credit 2. Pattern Transfer – Etching, PCB Drilling, component mounting 04 3. Soldering – Hand soldering, Dip Soldering, Wave soldering, necessary conditions for good soldering, Solders, Soldering defects, safety, health and medical aspects of soldering LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14023-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14023-TB1 T14023-TB2 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Electronic Components and Materials Shroff Publishers & Distributors private Ltd T14023 -RB1 Madhuri Joshi Printed Circuit Boards Tata McGraw Hill T14023 –RB2 Walter C.Bosshart Electronic Components and Materials Dhanpat Rai & Sons T14023 –RB3 Grover 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14023 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14023-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 37 T14024: ENGINEERING DRAWING -2 PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 02. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14024 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Engineering Drawing-2 Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Explain the basic concepts of projection Interpret and draw views of objects in different situations Visualize and Develop lateral surfaces of different solids Draw free hand sketches of machine elements UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 Sectional Views Missing Views Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 03 04 Projection of Solids Sections of Solids Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 05 Development of Surfaces Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Free Hand Sketches Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 06 DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Sectional Views: Introduction about Full Section, Sectional Side Views, Horizontal Section, Offset Section and Ribs in Section, Conversion of pictorial view into sectional orthographic views, Introduction about Third Angle Projection Method, Examples based on Sectional views 02 Missing Views: Introduction, Procedure to Draw Missing View from the given Orthographic Views, Examples based on Missing views 03 Projection of Solids: Introduction, Projections of Prism, Pyramid, Cone, Cylinder, Tetrahedron, Cube with their i) axes inclined to one reference plane and parallel to other (Axis Incline to HP and Parallel to VP , Axis Incline to VP and Parallel to HP), ii) Projections of same solids on auxiliary plane, Some More Typical Examples based on Projections of solids Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit Block Credit 01 Credit 02 Page 38 04 Sections of Solids: Introduction, Sections of Prism, Pyramid, Cone, Cylinder, Tetrahedron with their i) Section Plane Parallel to VP, ii)Section Plane Parallel to HP, iii) Section Plane Parallel to VP and Perpendicular to HP, iv) Section Plane Parallel to HP And Perpendicular to VP, Additional Problems Some More Typical Examples based on Sections of solids 05 Development of Surfaces: Introduction, Need and Uses of Developments of surfaces, Methods of Developments of surfaces, Developments of Lateral surfaces of cube, prism, cylinder, Pyramid and cone, Antidevelopment, Applications such as Chimney, funnel and Credit tray 03 06 Free Hand Sketches: Introduction, Terminology Used In The Screw Threads, V or Triangular Threads, I.S.O Metric Screw Threads, Screwed Fastening, Rivets and Riveted Joints, Types of Keys, Different Types of Coupling, Free hand sketches of machine elements such as nuts, Credit bolts, set screws, rivet heads, riveted joints, locking arrangements for nuts, threads, foundation bolts, Flange coupling and pulleys 04 LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14024-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14024-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Engineering Drawing 2010 Charotar Publishing House T14024 –RB1 N. D. Bhatt T14024 –RB2 Engineering Drawing and Graphics +AutoCAD K. Venugopal 2006 New Age Publication T14024 –RB3 Engineering Drawing R. K. Dhawan 2010 S. Chand Co. T14024 –RB4 Engineering Graphics K. R. Mohan T14024 –RB5 Engineering Drawing, Amar Phatak, Dhanpat Rai and Publication Co 2010 978-93-5004-016-4 Dreamtech, IS Code SP – 46. Engineering Drawing Practice for schools and colleges 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14024 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14024-WL1 T14024 –RB6 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 39 T14025: WORKSHOP PRACTICE (PROGRAMME SPECIFIC) PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 03. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14025 Course Name Workshop Practice (Programme specific) Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 120 120 100 TW Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘2 online SCORM lectures’ at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘2 face-to-face lectures (each of 45 minutes duration) at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each Term-Work or Practical session shall be of 240 minutes duration. Remaining time of 195 minutes after initial lectures of 45 minutes shall be used for actual conduct and reporting of Term-work/practical activities during each session. Evaluation Pattern: In total evaluation, Internal Examiner (IE) and External Examiner (EE) shall have 50% weightage. Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA) (Only by IE): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by EE): 20 Marks b. Viva on Term-Work Submission by the student: 30 Marks (by EE) + 30 Marks (by IE) PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand basic workshop practice like Turning, Sheet metal, plumbing and Welding Identify, use various tools and accessories during Electrical Wiring Installation Handle various tools and equipment’s used in mechanical, civil, electrical, electronics and computer field for assembly, testing and troubleshooting DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Credit Block Turning Shop: Introduction; Various marking, measuring, cutting, holding and striking tools; Drilling and Tapping: Working principle of drilling Credit 01 01 machine, Tapping dies its use, Turning: Plain, taper; Threading and knurling, safety precautions and safety equipments Introduction to Power Tools and utility items used in Electrical: Introduction to Advanced Power Tools like Pneumatic Spanner and Lifting 02 used in Electrical Engineering, Manually Operated and Motor Operated Tools used for Cutting and Drilling, Tools and Accessories used in Electrical Wiring Installation Welding Shop: Introduction; Types of welding, ARC welding, Gas welding, Gas Cutting; Welding of dissimilar materials, Selection of welding Credit 02 03 rod material, Size of welding rod and work piece; Different types of flame; Elementary symbolic representation; Safety precautions in welding safety equipments and its use in welding processes Sheet Metal Shop: Introduction; Various types of tools, equipment’s and accessories; Different types of operations in sheet metal shop; 04 Soldering and riveting; Safety precautions. Credit 03 Plumbing Shop: Introduction; Various marking, measuring, cutting, holding and striking tools; Different G.I. pipes, PVC pipes, flexible pipes 05 used in practice; G. I. pipes and PVC pipes fittings and accessories, Adhesive solvents chemical action, Piping layout Credit 04 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 40 Note: A) Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor B) i] One job of standard size (Saleable article shall be preferred) ii] Batch size should be selected depending on volume of work. iii] Job allotted should comprise of 6-8 hours of actual working iv] Student shall calculate the cost of material and labor cost for their job from the drawing Credit Questions UN Name of the Practical Activity Block Turning Shop: Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book 01 a) One job related to Drilling and Tapping b) One job related to plain and taper turning, Threading and knurling Format’ in CA and Perform Credit 01 ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva Introduction to Power Tools and utility items used in Electrical : for end exam on these units. a) Demonstration of Advanced power tools for example- Pneumatic Spanner and Lifting 02 b) Demonstration of Manually Operated and Motor Operated Tools for Cutting and c) Demonstration of Electrical Wiring Tools and Accessories 03 04 05 Welding Shop: a) Demonstration of different welding tools/machines b) Demonstration of on Arc welding, Gas welding, gas cutting and rebuilding of broken parts with welding c) Demonstration of any one composite job from involving butt joint lap joint welding process, from the following like Grill, door, window frame, waste paper basket, Kitchan Trolley, Corner flower stand chair , table frame (square pipe 25 mm) cooler frame (folding type), Centering plate d) One simple job on butt and lap joint or similar job from the respective discipline. Sheet Metal Shop: a) Demonstration of different sheet metal tools/machines b) Demonstration of different sheet metal operations like sheet cutting, bending, edging, end curling, lancing, soldering and riveting c) Demonstration of any one composite job from the following: Letter box, Trunk, Grain Container, Water-heater Container, Waste Paper Basket, Cooler Tray, Water-draining Channel, display board, Switch box, Battery eliminator box etc. (including soldering and riveting) d) One simple job on sheet metal operations and soldering and riveting or similar job from the respective discipline Plumbing Shop: a) Demonstration of different plumbing tools. b) Demonstration of different operation in plumbing, observing different pipe joints and pipe accessories, different samples of PVC pipes and PVC pipe fittings c) Demonstration on how to prepare actual pipeline layout for G.I. pipe or PVC pipe, actual drawing and bill of material d) One job on pipe joint with nipple coupling for standard pipe, pipe threading using standard die sets or similar job from the respective discipline Credit 02 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 03 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 04 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14025-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14025-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Workshop Technology Media Promotors and Publishers, New T14025 -RB1 S.K. Hajara Chaudhary Delhi Workshop Technology Dhanpat Rai and sons, New Delhi T14025 –RB2 B.S. Raghuwanshi Production Technology Khanna Publishers, New Delhi T14025 –RB3 R K Jain Workshop Technology Tata McGraw Hill Publishers,New Delhi T14025 –RB4 H.S.Bawa 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14025 -CD1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 41 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T04024-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 42 T14026: APPLIED SCIENCE AND ENGINEERING DRAWING -1 PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 03. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14026 Course Name Applied Science & Engineering Drawing-1 Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 120 120 100 P Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘2 online SCORM lectures’ at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘2 face-to-face lectures (each of 45 minutes duration) at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each Term-Work or Practical session shall be of 240 minutes duration. Remaining time of 195 minutes after initial lectures of 45 minutes shall be used for actual conduct and reporting of Term-work/practical activities during each session. 4. Two session per week, each of 240 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: In total evaluation, Internal Examiner (IE) and External Examiner (EE) shall have 50% weightage. Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA) (Only by IE): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by EE): 20 Marks b. Actual Conduct of Practical by the student: 20 Marks (by EE) + 20 Marks (by IE) c. Viva on Practical Report/Activity: 10 Marks (by EE) + 10 Marks (by IE) PART I: APPLIED SCIENCE PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Physics Understand concept and definition related to Rectilinear motion, Kinetics, SHM, acoustic, Illumination Verify the principles, laws, using given instruments under different conditions Interpret the results from observations and calculations Chemistry Analyze the various solutions used in chemical Laboratory Interpret the results by observing Chemical Reactions DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY Credit Block UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Course Content Covered in T04021: Applied Science course Credit 01 Course Content Covered in T04021: Applied Science course Credit 02 01 02 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity Credit Block Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Questions Page 43 Perform any seven (7) activities from Applied physics Course To represent simple harmonic motion with the help of vertical oscillation of spring and to determine 01 spring constant (K) (Stiffness Constant). To determine time period of oscillation of compound bar pendulum and calculate acceleration due to 02 gravity (g). 03 To compare luminous intensities of two luminous bodies by using Bunsen’s photometer. 04 To calculate coefficient of absorption for acoustical materials. 05 To determine Joule’s constant (J) by electric method. 07 To Verify Ampere’s rule using Oersted’s Experiment and finds variation of intensity of magnetic field with Current and Distance. To determine frequency of sound by using sonometer. 08 To calculate refractive index of material of prism using spectrometer device. 09 To determine coefficient of thermal conductivity of good conductor by using Searle’s method. 10 To detect surface cracks in the working piece by using liquid penetration method (LPT). 11 To determine the moments of inertia (I α and I β) of the given irregular body and to determine the rigidity modulus of the material of the given suspension wire by setting up a torsional pendulum. 06 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 01 Perform any seven (7) activities from Applied Chemistry Course 12 To determine neutralization point of acetic acid (weak acid) and ammonium hydroxide acid (weak base). To calculated normality and strength of acetic acid. 13 To determine the equivalent point of precipitation titration of BaCl2 with H2SO4 using conductivity meter. To find the normality and strength of BaCl2 solution. 14 To verify Faraday’s second law of electrolysis. 15 To determine pH of given solution by using pH paper, universal indicator and pH meter 16 To determine the strength of given hydrochloric acid solution by titrating it against sodium hydroxide solution by using pH meter. 17 To determine percentage of copper from brass iodometrically. 18 To determine thinner content in Oil paint. 19 To determine acid value of given lubricant. 20 To determine viscosity of given oil by using Ostwald’s viscometer. 21 To determine the saponification value of given lubricant oil. Credit 02 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Title Author Edition Year ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14026-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14026-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14021–RB1 Physics –I V. Rajendran Tata McGraw-Hill T14021–RB2 Applied physics Arthur Beiser Tata McGraw-Hill T14021–RB3 Engineering Physics R.K.Gaur and S.L.Gupta Dhanpat Rai Publication, New Delhi T14021–RB4 Fundamentals of Physics Resnick, Halliday & Walker Wiley India Pvt. Ltd T14021–RB5 Nano technology- principles and practices Dr. S K Kulkarni Capital publishing company T14021–RB6 Engineering Chemistry, Jain & Jain Dhanpat Rai and Sons T14021–RB7 Engineering Chemistry, S. S. Dara, S. Chand Publication T14021–RB8 Environmental Chemistry & Pollution Control, S. S. Dara, S. Chand Publication Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 44 T14021–RB9 T14021–RB10 Polytechnic Chemistry, Vedprakash Mehta, Jain brothers Industrial Chemistry, B. K. Sharma, 1st 2002 Goel Publication 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14026 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14026-WL1 PART II: ENGINEERING DRAWING -1 PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Draw and interpret different engineering curves, the given mechanisms and locus of points, orthographic and Isometric projections of different objects Use computer aided drafting packages available in Engineering field for drawing DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY Credit Block UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Introduction to Engineering Drawing: Introduction, Drawing Instruments and their Uses, Drawing Sheet Layout, Types of Lines and their Applications, Conventions for Material Representation, Lettering, Dimensioning, Geometrical constructions, Scales 02 Computer Aided Drafting: Introduction, Advantages of CAD, Hardware and other Devices, Basic Shapes and Objects, Understanding Co- Credit 01 ordinate System, About AutoCAD Package, Starting with AutoCAD, Various Command in AutoCAD and its Usage Engineering Curves and Loci of Points: Introduction, Classification of Curves, Conics, Mathematical Analysis of Conics, Ellipse, Parabola, 03 Hyperbola, Helix, Involute, Cycloidal Family of Curves, Archemedian Spiral, Loci of Points-Loci of Points With Given Conditions and Examples Related to Simple Mechanisms 04 Orthographic Projections: Introduction, Principle of Projection, Methods of Projection, Orthographic Projection, Principal Planes of Projection and Principal Views, System of Orthographic Projection, Analysis of Reference Line in Principal Views, Symbols for Methods of Projection, Analysis of Points, Lines and Planes in Principal Views, Procedure of Preparing Orthographic Views by using First Angle Projection Method, Precedence of Lines, Method of Drawing Hidden Lines, Method of Drawing Axis Lines, Orthographic Views of Elementary Objects, Identification of Surfaces, Fillets and Rounds, Dimensioning technique as per SP-46 Isometric projection: Introduction, Types of Pictorial Projections, Types of Axonometric Projections, Isometric Projection of a Cube, Key 05 Terms, Isometric View or Drawing and Isometric Projection, Construction of Isometric Point, Construction of Isometric Planes, Construction of Credit 02 Isometric Solid, Construction of Isometric Solid having Irregular Curve 06 Projections of Points and Lines: Introduction, Location of a Points (Various Positions), Conventional Representation, Projections of Points on Two Principal Planes, Projections of Points on Three Principal Planes, Auxiliary Planes, Projections of Points on Auxiliary Planes, Definition of a Straight Line, Traces of Lines, Location of a Line, Projections of Line, Projections of Line Parallel to Two Principal Planes and Perpendicular to the Third, Projections of Line Parallel to One Reference Planes and Inclined to the Other Two 07 Projections of Planes: Introduction, Various Types of Planes, Traces of a Plane, Various Positions of planes, Surface of Planes Parallel to One Principal Plane and Perpendicular to the Other Two, Surface of Planes Perpendicular to One Principal Plane and Inclined to the Other Two DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity 01 Introduction to graphics - (1 Sheet) Draw the following using AutoCAD i) Rectangle with given dimensions ii) Circle with given dimensions and hatch iii) Pentagon with line command iv) Hexagon with given dimensions v) Draw one figure containing circle tangent, arc and dimensioning 02 Engineering curves & Loci of points- (1 Sheet) i) Three different curves are to be draw using any one method. ii) Draw locus of point on any one mechanism 03 Orthographic projections - (Total 2 Sheets) Two objects by first angle projection method - (1 Sheet) Redraw the same sheet using AutoCAD - (1 Sheet) Credit Block Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 01 Credit 02 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform Page 45 04 Isometric projection - (Total 2 sheets) Two objects one by true scale and another by isometric scale. (simple objects) - (1 sheet) Redraw the same sheet using AutoCAD - (1 sheet) 05 Projections of line and planes. - (1 Sheet) Two problems on Projection of lines and two problems on Projection of Planes ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Title Author Edition Year ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14026-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14026-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14026 -RB1 Engineering Drawing N. D. Bhatt Charotar Publishing House T14026 -RB2 Engineering Drawing and Graphics +AutoCAD K. Venugopal New Age Publication T14026 -RB3 Engineering Drawing R. K. Dhawan S. Chand Co. T14026 -RB4 Engineering Graphics K. R. Mohan Dhanpat Rai and Publication Co T14026 -RB5 Engineering Drawing N. D. Bhatt Charotar Publishing House T14026 -RB6 IS Code SP – 46. Engineering Drawing Practice for schools and colleges 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14026 -CD1 Instructional / Learning CD developed by ARTADDICT 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14026-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 46 SEMESTER 03 T14031: BASIC ELECTRONICS PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14031 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Basic Electronics Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand basic principles, working and applications semiconductor devices Explain the operation of basic circuits like Rectifiers, Filters, Clipper, Clampers and Transistor Analyze the use of BJT and FET in Electronics Engineering UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 Semiconductor Devices Rectifier 03 04 05 Filters Circuits Wave Shaping Circuits Bipolar Junction Transistors Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 06 07 Biasing of Transistor Small Signal Amplifier Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 08 Field Effect Transistor Amplifier Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit Block Page 47 Semiconductor Devices: Concept of P-N Junction Theory; Formation of the Depletion Region; Barrier Potential, P-N Junction Diode, Biasing of P-N Junction Diode - Forward Bias; Forward Voltage Drop; Reverse Bias; Concept of Reverse Breakdown, V-I Characteristics; V-I Characteristics for silicon and Germanium Diode; Comparison of Ge and Si Diodes; Mathematical Expression for Diode Current (No derivation) ; Effect of Temperature on V-I Characteristics; Circuit Diagram to plot V-I Characteristics of P-N Junction Diode, Static (DC) and Dynamic (AC) Resistance, Specification of P-N Junction Diodes, Comparison of Ideal and Real Diode, Applications of P-N Junction Diode 01 Zener Diode - Operating principle; Circuit Symbol; Biasing of a Zener Diode; V-I Characteristics; Circuit Diagram to plot V-I Characteristics, Breakdown Mechanism - Zener Breakdown; Avalanche Breakdown in Zener Diode; Comparison of Zener Diode and P-N Junction Diode, Equivalent Circuit, Specifications and Applications of a Zener Diode Special Diodes - Concept, Construction, Working principle, Circuit Symbol, Equivalent Circuit, V-I Characteristics and Applications of i) PIN Diode, ii) Schottky Diode, iii) Tunnel Diode Light emitting Diodes (LEDs) - Concept; Construction; Working Principle; Colour of the Emitted Light; Voltage Drop and Current; Applications; Comparison of P-N Junction and LEDs, Infra-Red (IR) LED - Construction; Working principle; Characteristics; Applications PN Photodiodes - Concept; Construction and Working principle; V-I Characteristics; Why Photodiodes are Operated in Reverse Bias; Applications, Concept of Photovoltaic Cells, LASER Diode - Concept of Absorption, Spontaneous emission and Stimulated emission in Laser Credit 01 Diode; Construction and Working Principle; Characteristics; Applications 02 Rectifier: Concept of Rectifier, Types of Rectifiers, Half Wave Rectifier (HWR) - Concept, Circuit Details, Operating Principle, Waveforms, Performance Parameters such as Average DC value of Current and Voltage, AC or RMS value of Load Current and Load, Ripple Factor, Ripple Frequency, DC Output Power (Pdc), AC Output Power (Pac), PIV of Diode, Transformer Utilization Factor (TUF), Efficiency of Rectifier, Advantages, Disadvantages and Applications of HWR Full Wave Rectifiers (FWR)- Concept, Type of FWR, Centre-Tap FWR- Circuit Details, Operating Principle, Waveforms, Performance Parameters such as Average DC value of Current and Voltage, AC or RMS value of Load Current and Load, Ripple Factor, Ripple Frequency, DC Output Power (Pdc), AC Output Power (Pac), PIV of Diode, Transformer Utilization Factor (TUF), Efficiency of Rectifier, Advantages, Disadvantages and Applications of FWR Full Wave Bridge Rectifier- Circuit Operation, Performance Parameters, Advantages, Disadvantages and Applications of Bridge Rectifier, Comparison of Half Wave, Full Wave Rectifiers and Bridge Rectifier (Mathematical Analysis is not Expected for HWR, FWR and Bridge Rectifier) 03 Filter Circuits- Types of Filter Circuits, Series Inductor (or L) Filter- Principle of Operation and Waveforms; Expression for the Ripple Factor; Advantages; Disadvantages; HWR and Bridge Rectifier with L Filter, Shunt Capacitor (or C) Filter- Circuit Operation of FWR with C Filter; Ripple Factor and DC Output Voltage; Advantages; Disadvantages; HWR and Bridge Rectifier with C Filter, Choke Input (or LC) FilterPrinciple of Operation; Bleeder Resistor; Expression for the Ripple Factor; ; Advantages; Disadvantages; HWR and Bridge Rectifier with LC Filter, Capacitor Input(or pi) Filter- Principle of Operation; Advantages; Disadvantages , Comparison of L, C, LC and pi-type Filters 04 Waveshaping Circuits: Necessity of Waveshaping Circuits, Classification of Waveshaping Circuits, Linear Waveshaping Circuits – i) RC Integrator, Input and Output Voltage Waveforms of an RC Integrator for Positive and Negative DC Input, Step Input, Square Wave Input and Pulsed Input, Frequency Response of RC Integrator, Advantages, Disadvantages and Applications of RC Integrator, ii) RC Differentiator, Input and Output Waveforms of RC Differentiator for DC Input and Square Wave Input, Frequency Response of a RC Differentiator- Advantages; Disadvantages; Applications of RC Differentiator, Comparison of RC Integrator and Differentiator, Credit Non-Linear Waveshaping Circuits- i) Clipper Circuit using Diodes - Circuit diagram, Operation, waveforms, Transfer Characteristics of the 02 Series (Positive and Negative) and parallel (Positive and Negative) Clipper, Applications of Clippers, ii) Clamper Circuits using DiodesPositive Clamper; Negative Clamper; Clamper with Additional DC Source (Biased Clamper); Analysis of a Clamper Circuit; Application of Clampers. 05 Bipolar Junction Transistor: Fundamentals of BJT- Concept, Types, Construction, Unbiased BJT, BJT Biasing, Operation of NPN and PNP Transistor, BJT Circuit Configurations, Common Base (CB) Configuration - Current Relation; Input and Output Characteristics; Concept of Early Effect or Base Width Modulation; Breakdown Voltage; Experimental Setup to plot Characteristics; Feature of CB Configuration, Common Emitter (CE) Configuration- Current Relation; Reverse Leakage Current (ICEO); Relation between IC, IB, αdc and βdc; Input and Output Characteristics; Experimental Setup to plot Characteristics; Standard Tests for Saturation, Cutoff and Active Regions, Common Collector (CC)Configuration- Current Relation; Input and Output Characteristics; Experimental Setup to plot Characteristics; Feature of CC Configuration, Comparison of Configurations, Transistor as a Current Amplifier and Voltage Amplifier, Specifications of a Transistor, Transistor Applications, Transistor Testing using Multimeter. 06 07 Biasing of Transistor: Necessity of Biasing and factors to be considered while biasing, Transistor Load Line Analysis- Concept; DC load Line; Quiescent Point (Q Point) and its Selection; AC Load Line, Need of Stabilization of Q Point against Temperature, Changes in βdc , Variation in Parameters, Stability Factor, Stabilization Techniques, Fixed Bias Circuit- Analysis; Stabilization of Q Point; Base Bias with Emitter Feedback; Advantages and Disadvantages, Collector to Base Bias Circuit- Analysis; Stabilization of Q Point; Advantages and Disadvantages, Voltage Divider Bias or Self Bias – Approximate Analysis of Voltage Divider Bias; Exact Analysis using Thevenin’s Theorem; Self Bias as Constant Current Circuit; Advantages; Disadvantages, Emitter Bias- Analysis; Stabilization of Q Point; Advantages and Disadvantages, Comparison of Different Biasing Circuit, Thermal Runaway. Small Signal Amplifier: Concept of Amplification and Definition of Amplifier, Block Diagram of an Amplifier - Amplifier Characteristics, Credit Transistor as a Current Amplifier, Transistor as a Voltage Amplifier, Meaning of Small Signal Amplifier, Single Stage RC Coupled CE 03 Amplifier- Functions of Circuit Component; Operation; Graphical Analysis; AC Load Line; AC Equivalent Circuit, Frequency Response and Bandwidth of RC Coupled CE Amplifier- Concept; Fall of Gain in LF Range; Fall of Gain in HF Range; Bandwidth Amplifier, Common Base Amplifier, Emitter Follower Amplifier, Comparison of Transistor Amplifiers. Multistage Transistor Amplifier- Concept; Gain in Cascaded Configuration; Advantages of Log Scales, Coupling used in Amplifiers- Concept; Function of Coupling; Coupling Methods- RC Coupled CE Amplifiers, Transformer Coupled CE amplifier, Direct Coupled CE amplifier, Comparison of different Coupling Methods, Two Stage Amplifier- Concept; Circuit Details; Features, Frequency Response and Bandwidth of Cascaded Amplifier Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 48 08 FET Amplifiers: Introduction to Junction Field Effect Transistor (JFET) - Classification; Construction; Biasing of Gate to Source Junction; Unbiased JFET; Biased n Channel JFET and its Operation, Drain Characteristics and Transfer Characteristics, Comparison of JFET and BJT, Parameters of JFET- Drain Resistance (rd); Transconductance (gm); Amplification Factor (μ); Advantages, Disadvantages, Features and Application of JFET. JFET Biasing- Region of JFET Operation; Fixed Bias Configuration; Self Bias Configuration; Voltage Divider Biasing for a JFET; Comparison of Biasing Techniques; Source Bias for JFET; Current Source Biasing for JFET, FET as Voltage Variable Resistance (VVR) and its Application, Credit Common Source (CS) FET Amplifier- Circuit Description; Working, 04 MOSFETs - Types of MOSFETs, Construction, Working, Characteristics, Symbol, Features and Applications of Depletion and Enhancement type MOSFETs; Comparisons- Comparison of JFET and MOSFET; Comparison of JFET and DMOSFET; Comparison of DMOSFET and EMOSFET, Depletion Mode MOSFET Amplifier, Enhancement MOSFET as Switch- Passive Load Switching (MOSFET Inverter); Active Load Switching (MOSFET Inverter) LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14031-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14031-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Electronic Principles, T14031 –RB1 7th Albert Malvino Principles of Electronics, 10th Rev. Edn. T14031 –RB2 V.K. Mehta 2006 Electronic Devices and Circuits: An Introduction T14031 –RB3 Mottershead Electronic Devices & Circuit Theory, T14031 –RB4 10th Ed Boyle’stead & Nashelsky 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14031 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14031-WL1 9780070634244 Tata McGraw Hills 8121924502 S. Chand & Company 978-81-203-0124-5 PHI 9788131727003 Pearson Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 49 T14032: APPLIED MATHEMATICS -2 PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 03. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14032 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Applied Mathematics-2 Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Apply different methods and procedures for finding integration and differentiation Discuss the Numerical Methods and their applications Understand the concept of probability Apply the principles and concept mathematics to solve problems in Mechanical Field UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 03 Integration Methods of Integration Definite Integrals Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 04 05 Applications of Definite Integrals Differential Equations Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 06 07 Applications of Differential Equations Numerical Methods Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 08 09 Probability Probability Distribution Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 02 03 Credit Block Integration: Integration as Anti-Derivative, The Constant of Integration, The Symbol of Integration, Integration of Standard Functions, Rules of Integration, Composite Integrals, Integration of Rational Functions, Integration by Trigonometric Transformation Methods of Integration: Introduction, Integration by Substitution, Integration by Rational Functions, Integration by Partial Fractions, Credit Integration by Parts, Integration by Trigonometric Transformation 01 Definite Integrals: Introduction, Definition, Rules of Definite Integral, Properties of Definite Integral (Without Proof ) Simple Examples Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 50 04 Applications of Definite Integrals: Introduction, Tracing of Curves, Area under the Curve as a Definite Integral, Area between Two Curves, Volume of Revolution, Centre of Gravity or Centroid, Centroid of Plane Lamina, Moment of Inertia - Moment of Inertia of a Continuous Mass, Theorem of Perpendicular Axes, Theorem of Parallel Axes 05 Differential Equations: Introduction, Definition of Differential Equation, Order and Degree of a Differential Equation, Formation of Differential Equations - Arbitrary Constant, Pure Constant or Fixed Constant, Steps in the Process of Formation of Differential Equations; Credit Solution of a Differential Equation- General Solution, Particular Solution; Methods of Solving of First order Differential Equations; 02 Methods of Variables Separable Form; Equations Reducible to Method of variables Separable Form by Suitable Substitution; Homogeneous Differential Equations; Non-homogeneous Differential Equations; Exact Differential Equations; Linear Differential Equations; Bernoulli's Differential Equations 06 Applications of Differential Equations: Introduction, Rectilinear Motion under Uniform (Constant) Acceleration, Rectilinear Motion under Variable Acceleration, Simple Harmonic Motion (S.H.M.) 07 Numerical Methods: Introduction, Types of Numerical Methods- Bisection Method, Regular Falsi Method, Newton Rophson Method; Credit Solution of Simultaneous Equations containing 2 and 3 unknowns - Direct Method of Solution(Gauss Elimination), Iterative Method of 03 Solution (Jacobi’s and Gauss-Seidal) 08 Probability: Introduction, Some Basic Definitions- Experiment, Random Experiment, Outcomes, Sample Spaces, Event, Occurrence of an Event, Types of Events; Definition of Probability, Addition Theorem of Probability, Multiplication Theorem of Probability 09 Probability Distribution: Introduction, Probability Distribution of Random Variable - Mean of Random Variable, Variance of Random Variable; Binomial Distribution, Poisson Distribution, Normal Distribution – Graph, properties Credit 04 LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14032-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14032-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Mathematics for Polytechnic First T14032 –RB1 S. P. Deshpande Aug 2005 Calculus : Single Variable T14032 –RB2 Robert T Smith Advanced Engineering Mathematics T14032 –RB3 Dass H. K. Fundamentals of Mathematical Statistics T14032 –RB4 S.C Gupta and Kapoor Higher Engineering Mathematics, 40th Edition T14032 –RB5 Dr B S Grewal, 2009 Introductory Methods of Numerical analysis, T14032 –RB6 S. S. Sastry Numerical Methods for Scientific & Engineering Computations, M. K. Jain & others 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14032 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14032-WL1 T14032 –RB7 Pune Vidyarthi Griha Prakashan, Tata McGraw Hill S. Chand Publication, New Delhi S. Chand Publications New Delhi 81-7409-195-5 Khanna Publishers Prentice Hall Of India New Dehli Wiley Eastern Publication Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 51 T14033: BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14033 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Basic Electrical Engineering Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand and Measure various electrical quantities Apply concepts, principles, procedure and network theorems to analyze DC and AC circuits Explain concepts and applications of Electrical and Magnetic circuits, Electromagnetic Induction, Electrical Energy Storage Devices UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 DC Circuit Network Theorems Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 03 04 Fundamentals of Capacitors Electrical Energy Storage Devices/Batteries Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 05 06 Magnetic Circuits Electromagnetic Induction Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 07 08 AC Fundamentals Introduction to Power Quality Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Credit Block DC Circuit: Introduction to Electricity, Structure of an Atom- Important Definitions in Electricity; Concept of EMF and Current, Concept of Electric Potential and Potential Difference, Resistance, Factors Governing the Resistance Value- Conductance, Conductivity; Basic Definitions - Network or Circuit, D.C. Sources, Power, Electrical Energy, Circuit Element, Concept of Open and Short Circuit, Branch Mesh and Node, Resistors in Series, Resistors in Parallel, Division of Current among Parallel Resistors, Division of Voltage in the Series Connected Resistors, Comparison between Series and Parallel Circuits, Removal of Redundant Branches; Ohm's Law, Kirchhoff's Laws - Kirchhoff's Credit Current Law (KCL), Node Analysis, Kirchhoff’s Voltage Law (or Mesh or Loop Law), Examples on KVL and KCL; Concept of Ideal and Practical 01 Current and Voltage Sources- Independent Voltage Sources, Current Sources; Source Conversion- Transformation of Voltage Source to Current Source, Transformation of Current Source to Voltage Source, Voltage Sources in Series, Current Sources in Parallel; Circuit Simplification Techniques, Star-Delta and Delta-Star Transformation- The Star Network, The Delta Network, Delta-Star Transformation, Star to Delta Conversion Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 52 02 03 04 Network Theorems: Introduction, Network Technology- Classification based on i)Presence or Absence of Source, ii) the Direction of Current, iii) Separability of Components, iv) Linearity; Statement, explanation and application of i) Superposition Theorem ii) Thevenin's Theorem, iii) Norton's Theorem iv) Maximum Power Transfer Theorem; Principle of Duality. Fundamentals of Capacitors: Definition of - Coulomb's Law; Electric Field; Electrical Flux Lines or Electric Lines of Force; Electric Flux; Electric Flux Density (D); Electric Field Strength or Field Intensity; Permittivity, Concept and Definition of Capacitor, Capacitance of a Multiplate Capacitors, Derivation of Capacitors in Series and Capacitors in Parallel, Derivation of Energy Stored by a Capacitor, Current Flowing through a Capacitor, Charging and Discharging of a Capacitor through a Resistor, Dielectric Strength and Breakdown Voltage of Capacitors Electrical Energy Storage Devices/Batteries: Concept of Battery and Cell, Electrical Characteristics of Batteries-EMF; Battery Symbol and Credit its Terminal Voltage; Internal Resistance of Battery; Current Capacity and Call Ratings (AH Capacity); Battery Efficiency, Types of Battery, 02 Construction and Operation of Lead- Acid Battery, Charging and Discharging of a Lead- Acid Battery, Series and Parallel Connection Batteries, Charging of Batteries-Charging Techniques for a Lead – Acid Battery; Constant Current Charging ; Constant Voltage Charging; Battery Charging Circuits, Concept of Battery Aging, Introduction of a Fully Charged Cell, Battery Maintenance, Testing Procedure for Lead Acid Car Batteries, Application of Lead – Acid (Storage) Batteries 05 Magnetic Circuits: Concept of Magnet and Electromagnet, Laws and Definition of - Pole Strength; Laws of Magnetism; Magnetic Field and Magnetic Lines of Force; Magnetic Flux; Magnetic Flux Density (B); Magnetic Field Strength (H), Magnetic Field Associated with a Straight Conductor- Right Hand Thumb Rule and The Corkscrew Rule, Dot and Cross Convention, Permeability- Absolute, in Free Space or Vaccum and Relative Permeability, Magnetic Circuit - Definitions of Magneto Motive Force (MMF); Reluctance(S); Permeance; Ampere-Turns, Ohm's Law of Magnetic Circuits, Kirchhoff's Laws for the Magnetic Circuits- Flux Law and MMF Law, Concept of Series Magnetic Circuit and Parallel Magnetic Circuit with Expression, Concept of useful Flux, Leakage Flux and Fringing, B-H Curve or Magnetization CurveMagnetic Hysteresis and Hysteresis Loop; Hysteresis Loss; Hysteresis Loops for Hard and Soli Magnetic Materials; Factors Affecting the Hysteresis Loss, Fleming's Left Hand Rule 06 Electromagnetic Induction: Relation between Magnetism and Electricity, Development of Induced Emf and Current, Faraday's Experiments for Stationary Coil in a Moving Magnetic Field and Moving Coil with a Stationary Management, Faraday's First and Second Law of Electromagnetic Induction, Direction of Induced E.M.F- Fleming's Right Hand Rule and Lenz's Law, Induced E.M.F- i)Magnitude and Direction of Dynamically Induced E.M.F ii) Statically Induced E.M.F- Self Induced E.M.F; Self Inductance; Expression for the Coefficient of Self Inductance (L); Factors Affecting the Inductance of the Coil, iii) Mutually Induced E.M.F - Mutual Inductance (M); Alternate Way of Defining the Mutual Inductance; Expression for Mutual Inductance; Coefficient of Coupling (K), Effective Inductance of the Series Connection- Cummulatively Coupling of Coils; Differential Coupling of Coils; Series and Parallel Combination of Isolated Inductances, Energy Stored in the Magnetic Field-Expression for the Energy Stored in the Magnetic Field [No Derivation] AC Fundamentals: Difference between AC and DC, Advantages of AC over DC, Various Types of AC Waveforms- Definition of Waveform, Types of AC Waveforms, Sinusoidal AC Waveform, Graphical and Mathematical Representation of Sinusoidal AC Quantities; Generation of Single Phase AC Waveform - Single Turn Alternator, Generation of AC Sinusoidal Signal; Definitions - Instantaneous Value, Cycle, Time Period or Periodic Time, Frequency, Amplitude, Angular Velocity; Peak and Peak to Peak Voltage, Effective or R.M.S. Value - Analytical Credit 03 Method to Obtain the RMS Value; Average Value - Methods to Calculate the Average Value, Analytical Method; Form Factor, Crest Factor or Peak Factor, Phase of Representation of an Alternative Quantity, Phase of an Alternating Quantity- Phase Angle, Phase Difference, Leading and Lagging Phase Difference; Mathematical Representation of Phasor - Polar Representation, Rectangular Representation, Conversion from Polar to Rectangular, Rectangular to Polar Conversion; Addition and Subtraction of Phasors (Using Rectangular Fom1), Multiplication and Division of Phasors (Using Polar Fom1), Single Phase AC Circuits - Reactance and Impedance, Reactance, Inductive Reactance (XL), Capacitive Reactance (XC), Impedance (Z); Pure Resistance in AC Circuit - Analysis of the Purely Resistive AC Circuit, Voltage and Current Waveform and Equations, Phasor Diagram, Impedance of the Purely Resistive Circuit, Power in Purely Resistive Circuit, Energy in Purely Resistive Circuit; Pure Inductance in AC Circuit - Equations for Current and Voltage, Waveforms and Phasor Diagram, Inductive Reactance (XL), Power in a Purely Inductive Circuit, Energy Stored and Returned Back, Impedance of a Purely Inductive Circuit; Pure Capacitance in AC Circuit - Equation for Voltage and Current, Current and Voltage Waveforms and Phasor Diagram, Capacitive Reactance (XC), Power in Purely a Capacitive AC Circuit, Energy Stored and Returned Back, Impedance of a Purely Capacitive Circuit; AC Circuits with Series Elements, The Series R-L Circuit - Phasor Diagram, Impedance of L-R Series Circuit, Impedance Triangle, Phase Relation between Voltage and Current, Power in Series L-R Circuit, Power Triangle for L-R series Circuit, Apparent Power (S), Real Power or True Power or Active Power (P), Reactive Power or Imaginary Power (Q), Power Factor, Causes and Effects of Low Power Factor, Power Factor improvement; The Series R-C Circuit- Phasor Diagram, Impedance of RC Series Circuit, Impedance Triangle (Series R-C circuit), Phase Relationship between Voltage and Current (Series R-C Circuit), Power in Series R-C Circuit, Power Triangle for R-C Series Circuit; An R-L-C Series Circuit- Phasor Diagrams, Importance of the values of reactance (XL and XC), Impedance of Series LCR Circuit, Impedance Triangle for an LCR Circuit, Power Supplied to the R.L.C. Circuit, Power Triangle 08 Introduction to Power Quality: Definition of Electric Power Quality, Power Quality description events, Introduction to Harmonics, Harmonics and their classification, Sources for Harmonics, Effects of Harmonics. LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14033-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 53 T14033-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Electrical Technology ( Vol I To II), T14033 –RB1 B. L. Theraja Electricity: Principles and Applications, T14033 –RB2 Fowler Delmar’s Standard Text Book of Electricity, 2nd 1999 T14033 –RB3 Herman Basic Electrical Engineering, T14033 –RB4 2nd Ed V N Mittle and Arvind Mittal Electrical Circuits Analysis, T14033 –RB5 Soni and Gupta 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14033 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14033-WL1 S. Chand Publications, Delhi Mc Graw Hill 0-8273-8550-1 Delmar Publishers, Tata McGraw Hill, New Delhi Dhanpat Rai and sons New Delhi Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 54 T14034: ELECTRICAL AND ELECTRONICS MEASUREMENT PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14034 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Electrical and Electronics Measurement Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Define Characteristics of Instruments and Types of Errors Explain working principles of different types of DC and AC Voltmeter and Ammeter Describe measuring Instruments and meters with its Applications : Power and Energy, LCR meter, Cathode Ray Oscilloscope and Function Generator UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 Fundamentals of Measurements Measurement of Voltage and Current (DC) Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 03 04 Measurement of Voltage and Current (AC) Power Measuring Instruments Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 05 06 Three phase AC Power Measurement Measurement of Electrical Energy Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 07 08 Measurement of Circuit Parameters Other Meters used in Electrical Engineering Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 02 Credit Block Fundamentals of Measurements: Standard of Measurements- International; Primary; Secondary and Working Standards, Various Electricity Effects in Measuring Instrument-Magnetic; Thermal; Electrostatic; Induction and Hall Effect, Desirable Qualities of Measuring Instrument, Classification of Measuring Instrument-Absolute and Secondary Instruments; Difference between Absolute Instruments and Secondary Instruments, Error -Types of Error, Source Error, Definition of Static Error and Static Correction, Torque in Measuring Credit Instruments-Deflecting Torque (Td); Controlling Torque(Tc) and Damping Torque(T damp) 01 Measurement of Voltage and Current (DC): Classification of Measuring Instruments -Permanent Magnet Moving Coil Meters (PMMC); Dynamometer Type Measuring Instruments and Moving iron Ammeters and Voltmeters, Extension of Ammeters and Voltmeters Ranges Using Shunt and Shunt Multiplier, Disadvantages of using Shunt and Multiplier, Hall Effect Sensor Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 55 03 Measurement of Voltage and Current (AC): Extension of Ammeters and Voltmeter Ranges using Instrument Transformer- Extension of Ammeters Range; Extension of Voltmeter by Potential Transformer or Voltmeter Transformer (P.T.), Advantages of Instrument Transformer over Shunts and Multipliers, Error in Instrument Transformer, Burden of C.T, Precautions to be taken while using C.T, Calibration of D.C Ammeter and D.C Voltmeters using D.C Potentiometer, Introduction to optical CT and PT. 04 Power Measuring Instruments: Concept of Power in AC Circuit and its significance- Power Factor; Real Power or True Power or Action Credit 02 Power (P); Reactive Power or Imaginary Power (Q); Apparent Power (S); Power Triangle; Distinction between Active and Reactive Power , Wattmeter- Three Phase Power Measurement; Electro Dynamometer Types Wattmeter; Comparison between Analog and Digital Wattmeter, Errors in Wattmeter due to i)Method of Connection ii) Pressure Coil Inductance iii) Pressure Coil Capacitance iv)Mutual Inductance Effect v)Stray Magnetic Fields vi) Eddy Currents, vii) Temperature Error and viii) Vibration of Moving System, Polyphase Wattmeter-Induction Types Wattmeter, Multiplying Factor Wattmeter (MF), Extension of Wattmeter Range 05 06 Three phase AC Power Measurement: Introduction to Polyphase AC Circuits, Advantages of Polyphase Systems, Generation of a Three Phase Voltages with Mathematical Representation, Three Phase Star Connections (Wye Connection) and Delta Connections, Star Connection- Line Voltages and Phase Voltages; Typical Values of Line and Phase Voltages; Types of Loads; Star Connected Load, Delta Connected Load - Line and Phase Voltages in Delta Connected; Line Current and Phase Current for Delta Connection, Relations between Voltages and Currents for Star Connected Load- Relations between i)Phase and Line Currents ii) Phase and Line Voltages; The Complete Phasor Diagram and Power Relations, Relations between Voltages and Currents for Delta Connected Load- Relations between i)Phase and Line Currents ii) Phase and Line Voltages; The Complete Phasor Diagram and Power Relations, Power Triangle, Single Phase Power Measurement Using a Wattmeter, Power Measurement in 3 Ø AC Circuits, One Wattmeter Method for Star Connected Load and Delta Connected Load, Advantages, Disadvantages and Application of One Wattmeter Method, Three Wattmeter Method for Star Connected Credit Load and Delta Connected Load, Two Wattmeter Method- for Delta Connected Load, Power Factor Measurement by Two Wattmeter 03 Method - Variation in the Wattmeter Reading with Power Factor; Calculation of Reactive Power With Two Wattmeter Method; Merits and Demerits of Two Wattmeter Method, One Wattmeter Method(Modification of Two Wattmeter Method)- Power Measurement for Star Connected Load and Delta Connected Load, Disadvantages of One Wattmeter Method, Reactive Power Measurement using One Wattmeter Method Measurement of Electrical Energy: Construction of Single Phase Energy meter, Construction, Working and Specifications of Energy meter Energy meter Constant (K), Error in Induction Type Energy meters, Polyphase or 3 Phase Energy meter, Electronic of Energy meter Range, Electronic Energy meter, Calibration of Energy meter, Construction, working principle and operation of i) DC Energy meter ii)Bidirectional Meters, Automatic Meter Reading 07 Measurement of Circuit Parameters: Classification of Resistances, Measurement of Resistances by Voltmeter and Ammeter, Substitution Method of Measurement of Resistance, Wheatstone’s Bridge Method, Kelvin’s Double Bridge Method, Measurement of High Resistance Ohmmeter and Megger, Measurement of Resistance of D.C Line Mains, Measurement of Earth Resistance (Fall of Potential Method), Introduction to A.C Bridges , L.C.R. Bridges –Maxwell, Anderson and Wien Bridge, Measurement of Capacitance 08 Other Meters used in Electrical Engineering: Power Factor Meter - Single Phase and Three Phase Dynamometer Type, Frequency Meter Ferromagnetic Type OR Resonance Type; Moving Iron or Weston Type (M.I); Reed Type (Vibration Type Frequency Meter), Weston type Credit 04 Synchronoscope, Phase Sequence Indicator, Clip-on Ammeter (Application of a Current Transformer), Digital Multimeters, Q-meter, Cathode Ray Oscilloscope (CRO)- Block Diagram of CRO- Cathode Ray Tube (CRT); Vertical Deflection System; Delay Line; Horizontal Deflection System; Power Supply, Front Panel Diagram of CRO- Basic or General Purpose Controls; Controls Related to Vertical Section; Controls Related to Horizontal Section; Special Types of Controls, CRO Measurements- Voltage; Time Interval; Period and Frequency; Phase and Frequency Measurement by Lissajous Figures; CRO Pattern for Different Components, Block Diagram of Digital Storage Oscilloscope, Function Generator(FG)- Block diagram with function of each block; Front Panel of FG, AF Sine and Square Wave Generator LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14034-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14034-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! A course in Electrical & Electronics Measurement, 2005 8177000160, 9788177000160 T14034 –RB1 A. K. Sawhney Dhanpat Rai Publications Electrical Measurements and Measuring Instruments, 8121929636, 9788121929639 T14034 –RB2 2008 R. K. Rajput S. Chand Electrical Measurements and Measuring Instruments, 9380578768, 9789380578767 T14034 –RB3 2011 S. Kamakshaiah, Pannala Krishna Murthy, J. Amarnath I. K. International Pvt Ltd, Modern Electronic Instrumentation & Measuring Instruments, 1st Ed, 8120307526 , 9788120307520 T14034 –RB4 Heltrick A.D. & Cooper W.D 2009 Prentice-Hall, New Delhi 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14034 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14034-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 56 T14035: COMPUTER PROGRAMMING PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14035 Course Name Computer Programming Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 120 120 100 TW Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘2 online SCORM lectures’ at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘2 face-to-face lectures (each of 45 minutes duration) at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each Term-Work or Practical session shall be of 240 minutes duration. Remaining time of 195 minutes after initial lectures of 45 minutes shall be used for actual conduct and reporting of Term-work/practical activities during each session. Evaluation Pattern: In total evaluation, Internal Examiner (IE) and External Examiner (EE) shall have 50% weightage. Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA) (Only by IE): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by EE): 20 Marks b. Viva on Term-Work Submission by the student: 30 Marks (by EE) + 30 Marks (by IE) PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Write, debug, compile and execute simple ‘C’ programs using Different data types, Arrays, Decision and Control loops, Functions, Structure and File Handling Demonstrate basic algebraic and arithmetic computations in the Scilab environment DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Credit Block Introduction to ‘C’: History of ‘C’, ‘C’ the Beginner’s First Step, ‘C’ Tokens, The ‘C’ Character Set, Constants, Variables and Keywords- Types of Constants; Rules for Constructing Integer Constants, Real Constants and Character Constants; Data Types; Variables- Declaration, Declaring Variables as Constants, User Defined Data Type Declaration (Identifier), Data Type Conversions; ‘C’ Keywords, Operators such as Arithmetical, Relational, Logical, Assignment, Unary Arithmetic, Increment, Decrement, Conditional, Bitwise (Unary and binary Operator), 01 Special Operator, Precedence and Associativity Operator, Backslash Characters or Escape Sequences, #include Instruction, Pre-Processor Directive, Main Function, Executing a ‘C’ Program, Basic Structure of C Program, Formatted Input Output- Formatted Input; Formatted Credit 01 Output; Printf() with Integer Numbers; Output of Real Numbers; Outputting Single Character; Outputting Strings, Rules While Writing ‘C’ Program, Steps to Write and Run the Program Decision Making: Introduction to Controls, Decision Making Using if Loop - If Else Loop; If Else if; Nested if, The Switch Case Statement, 02 Break Statement, The While Loop, The goto Statement, The Do Statement - Nested Do While Statement, The For Statement - Nested For, The Continue Statement Arrays and Strings: Introduction, Arrays-One Dimensional; Declaration and Initialization of One Dimensional Arrays and Accessing Them; 03 Array and For Loop; Accepting Elements from User, Two Dimensional Array - Initialization; 2 Dimensional Arrays and For Loop, Strings - Declaration of Strings; Initialization of Strings; Table of Strings; String Handling Functions from Standard Library Credit Functions: Introduction, Need of Functions, Advantages of Functions, Elements of user Defined Functions- Function Declaration; Function 02 Call; Function Definition, Storage classes, Scope of Variables, Return Values, Functions with i) no Arguments and no Return Values ii) 04 Arguments and no Return Values iii) no Arguments and Return Values iv) Arguments and Return Values, Recursion, Call By Value and Call By Reference Structures: Introduction, Defining the Structure, Declaring and Accessing Members of Structures, Initialization of Structure Members, Array of Structure Credit File Handling: 03 06 Use of File, Types of File -Text and Binary, Sequential and Random File Handling, File Operations such as Read, Write, Open, Close and Append, Basic File Functions 05 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 57 07 Introduction to Scilab: Introduction, Scilab Environment, The Workspace and Working Directory, Matrix Operations, Sub-matrices, Statistics, Credit Plotting Graphs, Plotting 3D Graphs, Scilab Programming Language, Script Files and Function Files, Functions in Scilab, File Operations 04 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor [Students are expected to apply programming concept to Electrical Engineering Applications] UN Name of the Practical Activity [Perform Any 28 Activities) 01 Write a program to display various data types using format specifies for octal, decimal, hexadecimal numbering system 02 Write a programme to find the roots of quadratic equation 03 Write a programme to find greatest and smallest of three numbers using decision structure- if, if else, nested if etc 04 Write a program to display first class, second class, pass class and fail according to marks entered by the user 05 Write a programme to display menu options for performing 1. Addition 2. Subtraction 3. Multiplication and 4. Division operation on user defined input using switch case statement 06 Write a program for arithmetic calculator using switch case statement 07 Write a program to display reverse a number using for loop 08 Write a program to print prime numbers between 1 to 100 using decision making loops 09 Write a program to display sum of first n numbers specified by users using while loop 10 Write a program to display multiplication table of a number using do while loop statement 11 Write a program to accept a one dimensional array and display the array in ascending order 12 Write a program to create two matrices of 3 * 3 size and perform addition subtraction, Multiplication and division 13 Write a program to sort array elements in ascending / descending order 14 15 Write a program to demonstrate the use of Strlen (), strcpy (), strcat () and strcmp () functions Write a program to accept a string and arrange individual characters alphabetical order 16 Write a program to count the number of spaces in any one of the given string 17 Write a program to calculate area of circle using function 18 Write a program to demonstrate the use of call by reference and call by value functions 19 Write a C program to accept book details (book ID, author name, publisher name and price) by using the structure and display the same information as output 20 Write a Program to determine colour code for a single resistor band digit 21 Write a program to verify Ohm’s Law 22 Write a program to calculate 1) Series Equivalent Resistance If Three Resistance Connected in Series 2) Parallel Equivalent Resistance If Three Resistance Connected in Parallel 23 Write a Program to determine resonant frequency of a LC parallel circuit (L is 1mH, C is 1 uF, Resistance of inductor is 1 ohm) 24 Write a program to Calculate and Print Telephone Bill or Electricity Bill 25 Familiarization with Scilab Environment, The Workspace and Working Directory Help commands such as help, demo General commands such as clock, date , ver, Directory commands such as Change Directory, Workspace commands such as who, whos, what, clc, clf Termination commands such as quit, exit use of the built-in variable “ans” and “diary” Commands 26 Define two 3x3 matrix in Scilab and explore built-in Scilab Matrix operations such as addition, subtraction, multiplication, transpose, inversion, determinant, logarithmic, exponential functions and Element by element multiplication 27 To Explore built-in Scilab commands to create commonly used matrices, such as zero matrices, identity matrices, diagonal matrices, matrix with all elements 1 28 To illustrate the use of basic statistical functions available in Scilab such as are sum(), mean(), stdev(), st_deviation(), median(), max() and min() functions 29 Write a program to illustrate the use of any one of the following commands using Scilab: Looping (for, while) and conditional execution (if-then-else, select) 30 Write a program in Scilab to illustrate the use of plot2d(), plot3d() and subplot command for Sine waveform and Cosine waveform. Credit Block Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 01 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 02 Credit 03 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 04 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 58 31 Write a simple function in Scilab to calculate the length of a line in the x-y plane, given the coordinates of its two ends (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Title Author Edition Year ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14035-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14035-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14035 -RB1 Programming in ’C’, Balgurusamy 6th Ed Tata Mc-Graw Hill Publishing T14035–RB2 Let Us ‘C’, Yashavant Kanetkar 4th Ed BPB Publications T14035–RB3 Simplyfying C, Harshal A. Arolkar and Sonal Jain, 2nd Ed 978-93-5004-049-2 Dreamtech Press T14035–RB4 Introduction to Programming Using C, Pawar, Lad, Shinde and Patil 1st 2010 978-93-5004-048-5 Dreamtech Press, T14035–RB5 C programming Essentials, K N Dey and S Bandopadhyay T14035–RB6 C programming Dr. Vishal Lichade 9788131728895 Pearson Education 2008 9788177223347 Dreamtech 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14035 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14035-WL1 www.cse.iitb.ac.in/~cs626-449/scilab.pdf T14035-WL2 http://www.scilab.org/content/download/247/1702/file/introscilab.pdf http://www.scilab.org/content/download/370/2666/file/Scilab_Computation.pdf Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 59 T14036: BASIC ELECTRONICS , ELECTRICAL AND MEASUREMENT PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14036 Course Name Basic Electronics, Electrical and Measurement Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 120 120 100 P Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘2 online SCORM lectures’ at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘2 face-to-face lectures (each of 45 minutes duration) at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each Term-Work or Practical session shall be of 240 minutes duration. Remaining time of 195 minutes after initial lectures of 45 minutes shall be used for actual conduct and reporting of Term-work/practical activities during each session. Evaluation Pattern: In total evaluation, Internal Examiner (IE) and External Examiner (EE) shall have 50% weightage. Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA) (Only by IE): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by EE): 20 Marks b. Actual Conduct of Practical by the student: 20 Marks (by EE) + 20 Marks (by IE) c. Viva on Practical Report/Activity: 10 Marks (by EE) + 10 Marks (by IE) PART I: BASIC ELECTRONICS PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Handle and operate various electronics instruments and devices Measure characteristics of electronics devices Analyze, test and troubleshoot basic electronic devices and circuits DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY Credit Block UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Course Content Covered in T14031: Basic Electronics Credit 01 02 Course Content Covered in T14031: Basic Electronics Credit 02 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity [Perform Any 14 Activities) 01 To Observe and Draw the Forward and Reverse Bias V-I Characteristics of a P-N Junction Diode. Find Static and Dynamic Resistance of Diode 02 a) To Observe and Draw the static characteristics of a Zener Diode b) To Find the Voltage regulation of a given Zener Diode 03 To Study the Characteristics of Photodiode and LED 04 To Obtain the Load Regulation and Ripple Factor of a Half Wave Rectifier i) With Filter ii) Without Filter Credit Block Credit 01 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Page 60 05 06 To Obtain the Load Regulation and Ripple Factor of a Full Wave Rectifier i) With Filter ii) Without Filter To Plot frequency response of RC Integrator and RC Differentiator 07 To Study the use of diodes in wave-shaping circuits as a clipper circuits (Series and parallel Configuration) 08 To Study the use of diodes in level-shifting as a clamper circuits (Positive, Negative and Combination) 09 a) To observe and Draw the Input and Output Characteristics of a Transistor Connected in Common Base Configuration b) To Find α of the Given Transistor 10 a) To Draw the Input and Output Characteristics of Transistor Connected in CE Configuration b) To Find β of the given Transistor 11 To Study of Emitter Follower Characteristics 12 To Plot the Frequency Response of Small signal CE Amplifier 13 15 To Plot Frequency Response of Two Stage RC Coupled Amplifier using BJT a) To Draw the Drain and Transfer Characteristics of a given FET. b) To Find the drain resistance (rd) amplification factor (µ) and Tranconductance (gm) of the given JFET To Plot the Frequency Response of JFET Common Source Amplifier 16 To study Switching characteristics of MOSFET 14 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 02 LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Edition Year Title Author ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14036-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14036-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Electronic Principles, T14031 -RB1 7th Albert Malvino Principles of Electronics, 10th Rev T14031 –RB2 V.K. Mehta 2006 Electronic Devices and Circuits: An Introduction T14031 –RB3 Mottershead Electronic Devices & Circuit Theory, T14031 –RB4 10th Ed Boyle’stead & Nashelsky Electricity-Electronics Fundamentals: A Text-Lab Manual, 4th T14031–RB5 Zbar and Sloop, 1993 9780070634244 Tata McGraw Hills 8121924502 S. Chand & Company 978-81-203-0124-5 PHI 9788131727003 Pearson 0-07-113780-7 McGraw-Hill, 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14036 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14036-WL1 PART II: BASIC ELECTRICAL AND MEASUREMENT PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Verify experimentally different techniques and theorems used to solve AC and DC electrical circuits Understand and apply basic concepts and principles of electrical machines such as transformer, Motors and drives Measure electrical characteristics of components and devices with the help of commonly used equipment and instruments Analyze and troubleshoot the simple electrical circuits Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 61 DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY Credit Block UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Course Content Covered in T14033: Basic Electrical Engineering Credit 01 02 Course Content Covered in T14034: Electrical and Electronics Measurement Credit 02 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity [Perform Any 14 Activities) Credit Block 01 To Study Voltage Measurement using Voltmeters and Variable voltage power supply 02 To Verify Experimentally Ohm’s Law 03 To Verify Experimentally Kirchhoff's Voltage and Current Law To Study use of Multimeter for Measurement of AC and DC Voltage, Testing of Different Components and Continuity Credit 01 a) Verification of Superposition Theorem 05 b) Verification of Thevenin’s Theorem a) Verification of Norton’s Theorem 06 b) Verification of Maximum Power Transfer Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units 04 07 To Study Characteristics of Electromagnetic Induction and Devices 08 To Determine Power Factor of RLC Series Circuit 09 To Calibrate Moving Iron and Electrodynamometer type Ammeter/Voltmeter by Potentiometer 10 To Extend Range of Voltmeter and Ammeter by using PT and CT 11 To Use Megger to Measure the following: 1) Earth resistance and 2) Insulation resistance Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units 12 To Calibrate 3-Phase Energy Meter by Direct Loading To Measure 3-Phase Power using Two Single Element Wattmeter with 3-Phase Resistive and Inductive Credit 02 Load 14 To Measure inductance by Maxwell bridge To Measure AC/DC current, AC/DC voltage and resistance by using: 15 1) Digital Multimeter 2)Clamp on Meter a) To Measure Voltage, Frequency and Phase using CRO 16 b) To Obtain Transient Response of RC Circuit for DC Input 13 LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14036-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14036-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Fundamentals of Electrical Engineering, Everest Publishing House T14033 –RB1 M. N. Mittal Electrical Technology ( Vol I To IV), S. Chand Publications, Delhi T14033 –RB2 B. L. Theraja Electricity: Principles and Applications, T14033 –RB3 Mc Graw Hill Fowler Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 62 Electricity-Electronics Fundamentals: A Text-Lab Manual, 4th Zbar and Sloop, 1993 A course in Electrical & Electronics Measurement, 2005 T14034 –RB1 A. K. Sawhney Electrical Measurements and Measuring Instruments, T14034 –RB2 2008 R. K. Rajput Electrical Measurements and Measuring Instruments, T14034 –RB3 2011 S. Kamakshaiah, Pannala Krishna Murthy, J. Amarnath Modern Electronic Instrumentation & Measuring Instruments, 1st Ed, T14034 –RB4 Heltrick A.D. & Cooper W.D 2009 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14036 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14036-WL1 T14033 –RB4 0-07-113780-7 McGraw-Hill, 8177000160, 9788177000160 Dhanpat Rai Publications 8121929636, 9788121929639 S. Chand 9380578768, 9789380578767 I. K. International Pvt Ltd, 8120307526 , 9788120307520 Prentice-Hall, New Delhi Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 63 SEMESTER 04 T14041: INDUSTRIAL INSTRUMENTATION PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14041 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Industrial Instrumentation Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Explain Different Components of Instrumentation System Describe Construction and Working Principles of Different Transducers Explain various factor governs for selection of Transducer, Signal Conditioning Circuits and Data Acquisition Systems Design Instrumentation System for measurement of process variables UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Introduction to Instrumentation System Introduction to Transducers Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 03 Applications of Transducers Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 04 05 Signal Conditioning Circuits Data Acquisition System Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 06 Operation of Instrumentation System DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit [All units of this course should be taught without detailed Mathematical Treatment] Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit Block Page 64 01 Introduction to Instrumentation System: Basic Block Diagram of Generalized Instrumentation System with its necessity, Static Characteristics of Instruments - Accuracy and Measurement of Uncertainty; Precision, Repeatability and Reproducibility; Tolerance ; Range or Scale Range; Linearity; Sensitivity; Resolution; Drift; Hysteresis Effect; Dead Zone, Dynamic Characteristics of Instruments- Characteristics Equation of an Instrument in General Form ; Zero Order Instrument; First Order Instrument ; Response of First Order Instrument to Step Input; Dynamic Error; Settling Time ; Response of First Order Instrument to Ramp Credit Input; Second Order Instrument; Response of Second Order Instrument to Step Input; Response of Second Order Instrument For Ramp 01 Input, Calibration - Principles of Calibration; Calibration Chain and Traceability 02 Introduction to Transducers: Concept of Transducers and Definition, Classification of Transducers, Electrical & Mechanical Transducers, Advantages and Classification of Electrical Transducers, Analog and Digital Transducers, Resistive, Inductive Transducers, Potentiometers 03 Applications of Transducers: Measurement of Strain - Definition of Stress and Strain; Operation of Resistance Strain Gauge; Types of Strain Gauge; Construction of Unbonded and Bonded Metal Strain Gauge; Desirable Characteristics of Resistance Strain Gauge ; Materials Used for Strain; Strain Gauge Circuits; Wheatstone’s Bridge Configuration and Full Bridge Configuration; Temperature Compensation, Measurement of Force and Torque - Force Measurement using Load Cell and Types of Load Cell, Measurement of Torque Using Torque Cell Measurement of Temperature - Thermistor ; Thermocouple; Cold Junction Compensation (CJC); Thermocouple Types and their Ranges; Resistance Temperature Detector (RTD), Measurement of Displacement- LVDT (Linear Variable Differential Transformer)and Rotary Motion Measurement Using Optical Encoder, Credit Measurement of Pressure - Definition of Pressure and its Units ; Absolute, Differential and Gauge Pressure; Diaphragm Types Pressure 02 Transducers Using Four Element Strain Gauge Rosetters, Measurement of Flow - Mass Flow Rate; Volumetric Flow Rate; Difference between Mass Flow Rate and Volumetric Flow Rate, Measurement of Magnetic Field- Hall Effect; Hall Effect Transducers; Measurement of A.C. Current by Hall Effect Transducer, Measurement of Level- Float Types Level Sensor; Capacitive Measurement Method; Ultrasonic Level Measurement Method, Rotational Velocity- Optical Sensing; Inductive and Magnetic Types Pulse Pickups; Analog Tachometers; D.C. and A.C. Tachometers Measurement of Solar Radiation, Wind speed, RH, Light Intensity 04 Signal Conditioning Circuits: Operational Amplifier and its Characteristic Parameters- Block Diagram of Op-Amp; Features, Circuit Symbols and Terminals of Operational Amplifier; Op-Amp Equivalent Circuit; Ideal Voltages Transfer Curve; Op-Amp IC741 Pin Diagram and Pin Functions; Ideal Op-Amp Characteristics and; OP-Amp Parameters, Op-Amp Basic Circuits - Open-Loop Configuration; Closed-Loop Configuration; Virtual Ground Concept; IC741 Op-Amp based Unity Gain Amplifier or Voltage Follower; Integrator using Op-Amp 741; Differentiator Circuit using Op-Amp; Op-Amp Based i)Adder Circuit ii)Subtractor or Difference Amplifier iii) Inverting Amplifier Circuit or Inverter; Op-Amp Based i) V to I Converter and I to V Converter Circuit ii) V to F Converter; Instrumentation Amplifier using Op-Amp; Credit Differential Amplifier and Chopper Stabilized Amplifier using Op-Amp; Voltages to Current Converter with Floating Load and Grounded 03 Load; Op-Amp Based - Current to Voltages Converter, Sample and Hold Circuit-LF 398 Based Sample and Hold Circuit, Basic Comparator Circuit/Concept of Comparator, Zero Crossing Detector, Schmitt Trigger, Window Detector 05 Data Acquisition System: Necessity of Data Processing in Instrumentation, Generalized Data Acquisition System (DAS) - Block Diagram and Explanation; Objectives; Signal Conditioning in DAS; Ratiometric Conversion; Logarithmic Conversion; Types of Data Acquisition System, Analog to Digital Converter and Digital to Analog Converter using Op-Amp 06 Operation of Instrumentation System: Transducer Selection- Points to be Considered While Selecting a Transducer, Working of Instrumentation System - i) Temperature Measurement- RTD, Thermistor, Thermocouple ii)Force Measurements using Load cell iii) Credit Pressure Measurement Using Diaphragm Types Transducer iv) Speed Measurement by Non-Contact Type Method v)Displacement 04 Measurement by LVDT, RVDT vi) Rotary Motion using Optical Encoder vii)Flow Measurement by Electromagnetic & Turbine Flow Meter viii) Liquid Level Measurement by Resistive Sensor ix) A.C. Current RMS Indication Using Hall Effect Transducer LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14041-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14041-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Electrical and Electronics Measurement and Instrumentation, Dhanpat Rai & co T14041 –RB1 2012 A.K.Sawhney Fundamentals of Industrial Instrumentation and process control, 1st 9780070677494 T14041 –RB2 William Dunn 2009 McGraw-Hill Education Fundamentals of Industrial Instrumentation, 1st 9788126528820, 8126528826 T14041 –RB3 Alok Barua 2011 Wiley India Pvt. Ltd Op-AMPs and Linear Integrated Circuits, 4th 8120320581, T14041 –RB4 Ramakant Gaikwad 2009 Prentice Hall Of India rd Electronic Instrumentation, 3 0070702063, 9780070702066 T14041 –RB5 H. S. Kalsi 2010 Tata McGraw-Hill Education T14041 –RB6 Principles of Industrial Instrumentation, Tata McGraw Hill Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 65 D.Patranabis 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14041 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Video on Industrial Instrumentation by Prof. Alok Barua available at T14041-WL1 http://nptel.ac.in/courses/108105064/ T14042: TRANSFORMERS AND DC MACHINES PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14042 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Transformers and DC Machines( Please verify) Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Explain Construction and Working Principles of Various DC Machines and Transformer Analyze Characteristics of Electric Machines and Transformers Study Performance and Application of Single Phase and Three Phase Transformer and Machine UNITS UN Name of the Unit 01 02 03 04 05 CSs Questions DC Machines DC Motors Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Single Phase Transformer Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Three Phase Transformers Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Special Transformers Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit Block Page 66 01 02 DC Machines: Introduction - Types of DC Machines and Windings in a DC Machines, Principle of Operation of a Generator, Fleming’s Right Hand Rule, Magnitude and Shape of Induced EMF(Expression and waveform), Single Turn Alternator, Generation of AC Voltages, Construction of a DC Machine- Important Parts of DC Generator; Yoke; Poles, Pole Shoe and Pole Core; Field Winding ; Armature Core; Armature Winding; Commutator; Brushes, Armature Windings - Types of Armature Windings (Lap Winding and Wave Winding), Role of Commutator, E.M.F. Equation of a DC Generator-Types of DC Generators; Symbolic Representation of a Generator, Separately Excited Generators- Current Relations, Voltage Relations and Load Characteristics of Separately Excited Generator, Shunt and Series Self Excited Generators, Compound DC Generators - Long and Short Shunt Compound DC Generator; Cumulative and Differential Compound Generator; Load Characteristics, Various Losses in a Generator and its Efficiency, Applications of Different Types of Generators DC Motors: Construction of a DC Motor, Principle of Operation of DC Motor- Back EMF and its Significance; Methods of Improving Commutation, Voltage and Power Equation of a DC Motor, Torque Equation of a DC Motor- Types of Torque and Effect of Load on the DC Motor Operation, Types of DC Motors (Classification )- Shunt ; Series and Compound, Torque and Speed Equations, f Regulation, Various Characteristics of a DC motor, Characteristics of DC Shunt Motor- Torque-Armature and Speed-Armature Current Characteristics; SpeedCredit Torque Characteristics, Characteristics of DC Series Motor- Torque-Armature and Speed-Armature Current Characteristics; Speed-Torque 01 Characteristics, Characteristics of DC Compound Motor, Characteristics of Cumulative Compound Motor, Characteristics of Differential Compound Motor, Applications - DC Motor; Shunt Motor; Series Motor; Cumulative Compound Motor and Differential Compound Motor Applications, Selection of Motors for a Particular Application, Speed Control Methods of DC Shunt Motor - Flux Control Method; Rheostatic Control or Armature Voltages Control Technique; Armature Voltages Control Using a Potential Divider; Applied Voltages Control of a DC Shunt Motor; Ward Leonard Method for Speed Control, Speed Control of DC series Motor - Flux Control Method; Field Diverter Method; Armature Diverter Method; Tapped Field Method; Series and Parallel Connection of Field; Rheostatic Control (Armature Voltages Control); Applied Voltages Control, Need and Principle of a Starters, Three Point Starter-Basic Operation; Function of NVC or Hold on Coil; Function of the Overload Coil, Losses in D.C Machines- Copper or Electrical Losses; Core Losses or Iron Losses; Brush Losses; Mechanical Losses; Stray Load Losses; Power Stages, Efficiency of D.C Motor with Condition for Maximum Efficiency, Reversal of Direction of Rotation , Operation, Advantages and Application of Brushless DC Motor (BLDC Motor ), Construction, Working Principle and Applications of PMDC Motor and Generators 03 Single Phase Transformer: Transformer and its Types (1Phase&3Phase), Principle of Operation of Transformer, Faraday’s Laws of Electromagnetic Induction, Construction of Single Phase Transformer, Core Type and Shell Type Transformers, EMF Equation, Voltages and Current Ratios (Transformation Ratios ) of a Transformers -Voltages Ratios of the Transformer with and Without Load; Transformation Ratio (K);Turns Ratio; Types Based on the Value of k; Current Ratios, kVA Rating of Transformer, Losses in a Transformer- Copper Loss (Pcu); Iron Loss (Pi); Hysteresis Losses; Eddy Current Losses, Ideal Transformer, Phasor Diagrams of Ideal Transformer on i) No Load ii) Load, Practical Transformer- Phasor Diagram with i) Load ii)Capacitive Load iii) Resistive Load, Equivalent Resistance - Resistive Transferred to Credit 02 i)Primary Side ii) Secondary Side; Transfer of Reactance from i)Secondary to Primary ii)Primary to Secondary, Leakage Reactance and Its Effect, Equivalent Circuit of Transformer, Definitions of Efficiency and Regulation- Condition for Maximum Efficiency; Load at Maximum Efficiency; Voltages Regulation, Transformer Testing -Direct Method of Finding Performance; Procedure and Observations for i)Efficiency Measurement ii)Regulation Measurement, Approximate Voltage Drop -Expression for Voltage Regulation; Condition for Zero Voltages Regulation, Open Circuit Test (O.C. Test), Short Circuit Test (S.C. Test), All Day Efficiency of a Transformer with Examples, Simple Numericals based on content covered 04 Three Phase Transformers: Three Phase Transformers- Bank of Three Single Phase Transformers with Advantages and Disadvantages; Types of Three Phase Transformers with their Advantages and Disadvantages, Three-Phase Transformers Connections- Star-Star(Y-Y), Delta-Delta (∆-∆) and Delta-Star(∆-Y) Connection with i) Voltage and Current Relations ii) Merits and Demerits of Delta-Star Connection iii) Phasor Diagram iv) Applications, Star-Delta (Y-∆) Transformer- Voltage and Current Relations; Phasor Diagram; Advantages and Disadvantages of Star-Delta Connection; Application, Significance of Vector Grouping of three Phase transformers, Three Phase transformers Connection as per IS 2026 (Part IV)-1977- Line and Neutral Terminals; End Points of Phase Windings; Identification of Credit Winding; Series and Parallel Connection; Markings of Tapping; Connections, Open Delta or (V-V) Connection Power Supplied by V-V Bank, 03 Scott Connection 3 Phase to 2 Phase Conversion with Load Analysis and Phasor Diagram, Comparison of Power Transformers and Distribution Transformers, Selection of Transformers as Per IS 10028 ( Part-I)-1985- Selection Criteria for Distribution Transformers (upto and Including 1600kVA); Criteria for Selection of Power Transformers (Above 1600 kVA), Three Phase Autotransformer- Advantages, Disadvantages Applications, Autotransformer as Autostarter for a 3 Phase Induction Motor 05 Special Transformers: Singles Phase Autotransformer- Step Down and Step Up Autotransformer; Copper Saving in Autotransformer; Advantages, Disadvantages and Applications of an Autotransformer; Dimmerstat; Comparison of Autotransformer and Potential Divider, Instrument Transformers- Construction and Working principle of Current Transformers (CT) and Potential Transformers (PT), Welding Transformer- Characteristics (I-V); Reactors used with the Welding Transformer; Features, Disadvantages and Applications of Welding Transformer; Comparison of Welding Transformer and Two Windings Transformer, Isolation Transformers – Functions and Typical Specifications of Isolation Transformers; Disconnect the Load Instrument from Supply Ground ; Reduction of Voltage Spikes; Application of an Isolation Transformer LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14042-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 67 T14042-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! DC Machines and Transformers, 2nd 9788125916055, T14042-RB1 K Murugesh Kumar 2004 Vikas Publishing House Pvt Ltd T14042-RB2 Electric Machines, D.P. Kothari, I Nagrath T14042-RB3 Principle of Electrical Machines, V.K. Mehta, Rohit Mehta 4th 2010 9780070699670, McGraw-Hill Education, India. Reprint 2006 8121921910, 9788121921916, S. Chand Electrical Machines: Theory And Practice, 2007 M. N. Bando 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14042-CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14042-WL1 http://nptel.ac.in/courses/108105017/ T14042-RB4 812032997X, 9788120329973 PHI Learning Pvt. Ltd., Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 68 T14043: AC MACHINES PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 01 V55 T14043 AC Machines 4 45 120 100 TH Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand and Explain constructional details, working principles and characteristics of AC Machines Explain various operating parameters of AC Machines Explain applications of various Single phase and Three phase machines like Single phase and Three phase Induction motors, Three phase AC generators, three phase synchronous motor UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Three Phase Alternator Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Special Machines Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 Three Phase Induction Motor 02 03 Three Phase Induction Motor Starter and Speed Control Single Phase Motors 04 05 DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit Block Page 69 01 02 03 Three Phase Induction Motor: Introduction about Merits and Demerits of Induction Motors over DC Motor with Applications, Production of Rotating Magnetic Field (RMF), Speed and Direction of RMF, 3-Phase Induction Motor - Construction and Parts of Motor and their Functions, Types of Induction Motor- Wound Rotor or Slip Ring Type Rotor and Squirrel Cage Rotor, Principle of Operation of 3-Phase Induction Motor, Electrical Characteristics of Induction Motors- Synchronous Speed (Ns );Slip; Rotor Induced emf frequency (fr); Induced Voltages in the Rotor; Rotor Resistance; Rotor Reactance; Rotor Impedance; Rotor Power Factor; Rotor Current ; Power Transferred, Effect of Loading on Induction Motor, Torque Equation of Induction Motor- Full Load Torque; Starting Torque; Condition for Maximum Torque and Expression for Maximum Torque, Torque-Slip Characteristics of Induction Motor, Various Torque Ratios for an Induction Motor- Credit 01 Starting Torque to Maximum Torque Ratio, Effect of Change in i)Rotor Resistance on Torque Developed ii) Supply Voltage Torque Slip Characteristics, Measurement of Slip- Actual Speed Measurement; By Comparison of Rotor and Stator Frequencies; Stroboscopic Method for Measurement of Slip; Measurement of Slip by Tachometer Method, Variable Losses and Constant Losses in Induction Motor, Vector Diagram and Power Flow Diagram for Induction Motor, Efficiency of an Induction Motor, Induction Motor as a Transformer, Equivalent Circuit of Induction Motor - Referred to Stator and Approximate Equivalent Circuit [Simple Numericals on content covered] Three Phase Induction Motor - Starter and Speed Control: Need of Starter for Induction Motor, Types of Starters -Stator Resistance Starter; Autotransformer Starter; Star-Delta Starter; Rotor Resistance Starter; Variable Frequency Starting; Direct on Line (DOL) Starters, Speed Control of three Phase Induction Motor - Stator Voltages Control; Stator Frequency Control or V/F Control; Controlling the Number of Poles; Change in Stator Resistance; Speed Control using External Rotor Resistance, Reversal of Direction of Rotation, Applications of Squirrel Cage Motors and Slip Ring Induction Motors, Double Cage Induction Motor- Construction; Working principle and Characteristics Credit Single Phase Motors : Construction of Single Phase Induction Motors(IM), Double Revolving Field Theory, Torque Speed Characteristics of 02 Single Phase Induction Motor, Split Phasing Principal of Starting, Types of Single Phase Induction Motor, Split Phase IM (Resistance start Induction Run )- Principle of Operation; Phase Diagram; Torque Speed Characteristics; Applications of Split Phase IM, Phase Diagram and Torque Speed Characteristics of Capacitor Start Induction Run Motor, Capacitor Start Capacitor Run Motor- Phase Diagram, Role of Capacitor and Applications, Shaded Pole Induction Motors with Advantages, Disadvantages and Applications [Simple Numericals on content covered] 04 Three Phase Alternator: Definition of Alternator, Classification of Alternators, Construction of an Alternators- Stator Construction; Construction of a Rotor; Difference between Salient Pole and Smooth Cylindrical Rotor; Excitation System; Ventilation System; Slip Ring and Brush Assembly, Advantages of Rotating Field Construction over the Rotating Armature Construction, Single Turn Alternator (Rotating Armature Type)- Generation of AC Voltages; Salient and Non-Salient pole Construction; 4-Pole Alternator, Induced (Generated) EMFFrequency of Induced EMF; Synchronous Speed (Relation Between Synchronous Speed and Frequency); Construction of a 3 Phase Alternator; Simplified Operation of a Moving Armature Alternator (2-Pole and 4-Pole), Relation between the Synchronous Speed and Frequency of the Induced EMF, Armature Windings and Related Definitions, Types of Armature Windings - Single Layer and Double Layer Credit Winding; Concentric or Distributed Windings; Full Pitch and Short Pitch winding; Pitch Factor or Coil Span Factor (Kc or KP); Distribution 03 Factor or Breadth Factor or Winding Factor or Spread Factor (Kd), E.M.F. Equation of an Alternator, Parameters of Armature WindingArmature Resistance Ra and Armature Leakage Reactance XL, Armature Reaction - Effect of i) Lagging Power Factor Load ii)Unity Power Factor Load iii) Zero Leading Power Factor, Concept of Synchronous Reactance (XS) and Impedance (Z S), Voltages Equivalent and Factors affecting the Terminal Voltages, Equivalent Circuit, Rating, Losses and Efficiency of an Alternator, Regulation of an Alternator by Synchronous Impedance Method - Open Circuit test; Short Circuit Test; Determination of Synchronous Impedance ZS and Regulation Calculations, Regulation by MMF (Ampere Turns ) Method - Regulation Calculations and Drawback of MMF Method [Simple Numericals on content covered] 05 Special Machines: Sector Induction Motor-Linear Induction Motor, Single Phase A.C Series with Motor Modifications and Torque-Speed Characteristics, Universal Motor- Uncompensated and Compensated Universal Motor; Speed Range and Direction Reversal; Advantages, Disadvantages and Applications of Universal Motor, Induction Generator -Principle of Operation; Applications, Advantages, Limitations and Drawbacks of Induction Generator, Servomotors- A.C. Servomotor; Torque-Speed Characteristics; Advantages and Applications of AC Servomotors, Types of Servomotors, DC Servomotors- Field Controlled DC Servomotors; Armature Controlled DC Servomotors; Applications of DC Servomotors, Advantages and Classification of Stepper Motor, Single Stack Variable Reluctance (V.R) Stepper Motor with Advantages, Permanent Magnet Step Motors with its Advantages and Drawbacks, Hybrid Step Motors with its Advantages, Important Definitions Related to Stepper Motors, Static and Dynamic Characteristics of Stepper Motors, Applications and Limitations of Stepper Motor LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14043-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14043-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Electrical Machines 3rd 007066921X, 9780070669215 T14043 –RB1 S. K. Bhattacharya 2008 Aug Tata McGraw - Hill Education, New Delhi Induction and Synchronous Machines 1st 9788125909262 T14043 –RB2 K Murugesh Kumar 2000 Vikas publication House Pvt.Ltd Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 70 T14043 –RB3 Electrical Machines Vol-II K Murugesh Kumar 1st 2010 A Textbook of Electrical Technology: Volume II: AC & DC Machines 23rd Theraja & A.K. Theraja Revised Ed 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14043 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14043-WL1 http://www.scilab.in/textbook_companion/generate_book/431 T14043 –RB4 9788125939474 Vikas publication House Pvt.Ltd 8121924375 / 9788121924375 S. Chand & Company Ltd. Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 71 T14044: ELECTRICAL POWER GENERATION PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14044 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Electrical Power Generation Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand and Explain Concepts, Principles and Operation of Electrical Power Generation - Thermal Power, Hydro Power, Nuclear Power, Diesel Power, Wind Power and Solar Power Explain various factors to be consider for selection of power plant site Explain the Economics of Power Generation with factors affecting on it UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 Basics of Power Generation Thermal Power Plant Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 03 04 Hydro Electric Power Plant Diesel Electric Power Plant Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 05 06 Nuclear Power Plant Economics of Power Generation Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 07 08 Interconnected Power Systems Renewable Energy Sources Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 02 Credit Block Basics of Power Generation : Introduction about Electric Power System, Types of Energy Sources, Generating Stations, Prediction of Load and Energy Requirement, Comparison between Conventional and Non-conventional Energy Sources, Fuels - Solid, Liquid and Gaseous, their Calorific Values, Advantages and Disadvantages of these Fuels Thermal Power Plant: Concept of Thermal Power Plant, List of Thermal Power Plants in State and Country with their Capacities, Selection Credit of Site for Thermal Power Plant , Block Diagram of Thermal Power Plant, Quality of Fuel and its Effect on Quality of Power Generation 01 Classification and Analysis of coal, Operation of Different Components, Electrical Equipment’s used in Thermal Power Plant, Advantages and Disadvantages of Thermal Power Plant Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 72 03 04 05 06 07 08 Hydro Electric Power Plant: Concept of Hydro Power Plant, Selection of Site for Hydro Power Plant, Layout of Hydro Electric Plant, Function of Different Components of Hydro Power Plant, Various Turbines used – Low head and High Head Turbine and Types, Water Hammer and Cavitation Effect, Specific Speed, Electrical Equipment’s used in Hydro Power Plan , Classification of Hydro Electric Plants According to i)Quantity of Available Water ii) Available Head iii) Nature of Plants iv) Pumped storage power plants, Advantages and Credit Disadvantages of Hydro Electric Plants, List of Hydro Electric Power Plant In Maharashtra and Country 02 Diesel Electric Power Plant : Concept of Diesel Electric Power, Applications of Diesel Power Stations, Block Diagram of Diesel Power Plant Engine; Fueling System; Air Intake System; Exhaust System; Cooling System; Lubricating System; Engine Starting System, Maintenance of Diesel Power Stations, Captive Power Generation- Types, Advantages and Disadvantages, Introduction to AVR (Automatic Voltage Regulator), Auto Mains Failure Panel (AMFP) with the help of Block Diagram Nuclear Power Plant : Concept of Nuclear Power Plant- Atomic Physics; Nuclear Fission ; Chain Reaction, Block Diagram of Nuclear power Plant- Nuclear Reactor; Heat Exchanger; Steam Turbine; Alternator; Condenser and Cooling Tower, Fuels used in Nuclear Power Plant, Classification of Nuclear Reactors as Advanced Gas Cooled Reactor (AGC), Boiling Water Reactors, Pressurized Water Reactor and LiquidMetal Fast-Breeder Reactor, Selection of Site for Nuclear Power Plant, Principle of Control of Nuclear reactor, Disposal of Nuclear Waste Credit and Nuclear Shielding, Advantages and Disadvantages of Nuclear Power Plant, List of Nuclear Power Plant in State and Country 03 Economics of Power Generation : Definition of Economics of Power Generation, Terms Commonly used in System Operation, Curves used in System Operation- Load Curve; Load Duration Curve; Integrated Duration curve, Factors Affecting the Cost of Generation, Importance of High Load Factor, Choice of Size and Number of Generator Units, Difficulties in Selecting Number of Units ( Simple Numericals) Interconnected Power System: Definition of Interconnected Power System, Merits and Limitation of Interconnected Power System, Comparison of Various Types of Power Stations, Base Load and Peak Load Concept, Combined Operation of Power Stations, Load Allocation among Various Types of Power Stations, Economic Loading of Generators, Economic Loading of Inter Connected Stations, Load Sharing and Transfer of Load between Power Stations- Necessity of Reactance for an Interconnected Stations; Load Sharing, Interconnection of Power Stations at State and National Level Renewable Energy Sources: Importance of Renewable Energy Sources, Types of Renewable Sources -Conventional and Non-Conventional Types; Renewable Energy Types, Solar Radiation- Potential of Solar Energy; Direct Radiation, Diffused Radiation; Solar Constant, Solar Credit 04 Collectors, Solar Thermal Power Plant - Open Volumetric Air Receiver Concept; Pressurized Air Receiver Concept; Advantages, Solar Photovoltaic Systems- Construction and Principle of Working; Characteristics of Solar Cell; Solar Cell Materials; Important Terms related to solar panel; Stand-Alone DC/AC system; PV – Generator Combination, Solar PV Application, Advantages & Disadvantages of Solar Energy, Wind Energy- Wind Energy and Its Importance; Wind to Electric Energy Conversion System; Selection of Sites for Wind Mills, Block Diagram of Wind Energy Conversion System - Variable Speed Constant Frequency System ( VSCF) and Constant Speed Constant Frequency System (CSCF), Types of wind Turbines - Horizontal Axis wind Turbines(HAWT) and Vertical Axis wind Turbines(VAWT) with Comparison between them, Advantages and Limitations of Wind Energy Conversion, Grid Connected System- Grid Feed and Grid Supported LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14044-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14044-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Electric Power Generation, Transmission and Distribution 2nd Ed 9788120335608 T14044 –RB1 S. N. Singh 2008 Prentice-hall Of India Pvt Ltd 3rd Ed Solar Energy, 0070260648 T14044 –RB2 2008 S. P. Sukhatme The McGraw-Hill Companies T14044 –RB3 Generation of Electrical Energy, B. R. Gupta 6th Ed 2010 9788121901024, 8121901022 S. Chand Publisher T14044 –RB4 Principles of Power System, V. K. Mehta & Rohit Mehta 3rd 2005 8121924960, 9788121924962 S. Chand & Co Ltd T14044 –RB5 Generation Distribution and Utilization of Electrical Energy, Wadhwa, C L 3rd 2012 978-81-224-2821-6 New Age International (P) Ltd Electrical Power Systems Reprint Wadhwa, C L Apr, 2014 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14044-CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! SCILAB T EXTBOOK COMPANION FOR P RINCIPLES OF P OWER S YSTEMS T14044-WL1 www.scilab.in/textbook_companion/generate_book/98 T14044 –RB6 978-81-224-2839-1 New Age International (P) Ltd Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 73 T14045: INDUSTRIAL INSTRUMENTATION AND BASIC MECHANICAL ENGINEERING PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14045 Course Name Industrial Instrumentation and Basic Mechanical Engineering Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 120 120 100 TW Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘2 online SCORM lectures’ at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘2 face-to-face lectures (each of 45 minutes duration) at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each Term-Work or Practical session shall be of 240 minutes duration. Remaining time of 195 minutes after initial lectures of 45 minutes shall be used for actual conduct and reporting of Term-work/practical activities during each session. Evaluation Pattern: In total evaluation, Internal Examiner (IE) and External Examiner (EE) shall have 50% weightage. Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA) (Only by IE): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by EE): 20 Marks b. Viva on Term-Work Submission by the student: 30 Marks (by EE) + 30 Marks (by IE) PART I: INDUSTRIAL INSTRUMENTATION PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Identify different components of instrumentation system Select the transducer as per measurement application Analyze and test given instrumentation system and its circuits DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY Credit Block UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Course Content Covered in T14041: Industrial Instrumentation Credit 01 02 Course Content Covered in T14041: Industrial Instrumentation Credit 02 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity [Perform Any 14 Activities) 01 To Study Displacement Measurement by using LVDT 02 To Study Pressure Measurement by using Strain Gauge 03 To Plot the Characteristics of RTD (PT-100) and Thermocouple 04 To Study Level Measurement and Verify the Characteristics of the Transducer 05 To Study Speed Measurement by using Tachometer 06 To Study Displacement or Position Measurement by using Rotary Encoder 07 To Study Pressure Measurement using Diaphragm type Pressure Gauge 08 To Plot Characteristics of Primary and Secondary Current for a Current Transformer 09 To Verify and Plot the graph of the characteristics of LDR/Photo diode and Photo Transistor Credit Block Credit 01 Credit 02 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Students have to submit Page 74 10 To Study Speed Measurement Using different Optical Encoders 11 12 To Study of the Performance Characteristics of Level Transducer and Flow of a Fluid To Verify working of Inverting and Non-inverting Amplifier using OPAMP 13 To Verify Adder and Subtractor circuit operation using OPAMP 14 To Verify the function of OPAMP as Comparator and Schmitt Trigger 15 To Verify Operation Op-Amp as an Instrumentation Amplifier 16 To Study Digital to Analog Converter using OPAMP ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Edition Year Title Author ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14045-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14045-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Electrical and Electronics Measurement and Instrumentation, T14041 –RB1 2012 A.K.Sawhney Fundamentals of Industrial Instrumentation and process control, 1st T14041 –RB2 William Dunn 2009 Fundamentals of Industrial Instrumentation, 1st T14041 –RB3 Alok Barua 2011 Op-AMPs and Linear Integrated Circuits, 4th T14041 –RB4 Ramakant Gaikwad 2009 Electronic Instrumentation, 3rd T14041 –RB5 H. S. Kalsi 2010 Principles of Industrial Instrumentation, T14041 –RB6 D.Patranabis Dhanpat Rai & co 9780070677494 McGraw-Hill Education 9788126528820, 8126528826 Wiley India Pvt. Ltd 8120320581, Prentice Hall Of India 0070702063, 9780070702066 Tata McGraw-Hill Education Tata McGraw Hill 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14045-CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14045-WL1 PART II: BASIC MECHANICAL ENGINEERING PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand mechanical aspect of Steam Power Plant, IC Engine, Air Compressor, Pumps, Hydro Power Plant, Wind Turbine while doing electrical installations and maintenance Handle equipment that are used for generation of electrical power Understand various process, different mountings and accessories of mechanical equipment DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Credit Block Boilers, Steam Turbine, Steam Engine: Introduction of Supercritical Boiler with Specific Advantages, Similarity and Difference between Subcritical and Supercritical Boilers, Construction and Working of Critical Boilers- Principal of Working of Benson Boiler with its Salient Features and Advantages, Construction and Working of Super Critical Boiler – Construction; Working; Advantages of Supercritical Boiler, Credit 01 01 Boilers Efficiency - Combustion Efficiency and Annual or Seasonal Efficiency, Boilers Act (for Remedial Measure)-Definitions ; Alterations and Renewals to Boiler; Alterations and Renewals to Steam-pipes; Erosion Phenomenon and Remedial Measures, Steam Turbine - Classification of Turbine; Principal of Operation, Steam Turbine According to Supply and Exhaust Conditions with Applications; Casing or Shaft Arrangements, Impulse and Reaction Turbine, Power Developed by Turbine, Different Power Loss in Turbine Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 75 02 Internal Combustion (IC) Engines : Engines Terminology, Classification of IC Engine, Testing of IC Engine - Indicated Power; Brake Power; Friction Power; Measurement of i) Fuel Consumption ii)Heal Carried by Jacket Cooling Water iii)Air Supply to IC Engine iv)Heat Carried Away by Exhaust Gases, The Engine Performance Characteristics- Power and Torque; Output Curve ; Torque Curve; Brake Specific Fuel Consumption Curve , Fault Finding and Remedial Measures , Starting System -Starting Motor or Cranking Motor; Drive Unit; Starter Solenoid Air Compressor : Concept of Air Compressors, Use of Compressed Air, Classification of Air Compressors according to the i)Capacity ii)Pressure Limit iii) Method of Connection to the Driving unit, Definition - Compression ratio ; Compressor Capacity; Free Air Delivered (FAD); Swept Volume; Pressure ratio , Reciprocating Air Compressor - Construction and Working of Single-Stage Single Acting Reciprocating 03 Compressors ; Indicator Diagram ; Single Acting Compressor; Double Acting Reciprocating Compressor; Two Stage Air Compressor, Rotary Credit Compressors –Fans; Blowers ; Positive Displacement Compressor; Non-Positive Displacement Rotary or Steady Flow Compressor, Methods of 02 Energy Saving in Air Compressors -Inter-Stage Cooling; Water Jacketing; Another Method for Energy Saving, Air Compressor Trouble Shooting Pumps : Types of Hydraulic Pumps - Reciprocating Pump - Efficiency and Common Problems; Double Acting Pump; Power Required to Drive a Reciprocating Pump; Centrifugal Pump- Construction, Difference between Centrifugal and Reciprocating Pump, Working Principle of Rotary 04 Pumps -Working of Gear, Vane , Lobe and Screw Pumps, Peristaltic Pump Power Required to Drive the Centrifugal Pump (Work Done By a Centrifugal Pump)- Manometric Head HM and Pumping Power , Fault Finding and Remedial Action in Pumps DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor Credit Block UN Name of the Practical Activity [Perform Any 10 Activities) 01 Demonstration and Study of various types of Boilers Mountings and Accessories with the help of Model 02 To Study Foundation and Working of Boiler 03 To Study Foundation and Working of Turbine 04 To Study Operation of Condenser 05 To Study Operation of Cooling Tower 06 To Conduct Test on Diesel Engine to Find Break Power, Indicated Power and Frictional Power 07 To Observe the Operation of IC Engine and Identify types of Faults and Suggest Remedial Measures 08 List Out Various Components in Domestic Window Air Conditioner and Explain Working Principle of Domestic Window Air Conditioner with Schematic Diagram 09 To Observe the Operation of Air Compressor for Identification of Sources of Air Leakage 10 To Observe the Operation of Air Compressor and Identify Types of Faults and Suggest Remedial Measures 11 12 Credit 01 Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 02 To Observe the Operation of Reciprocating Pump and Identify Types of Faults and Suggest Remedial Measures To Determine Overall Efficiency of a Centrifugal Pump by Conducting a Trial Test on it and Observe Foundation of Pump LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Title Author Edition Year ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14045-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14045-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Basic Mechanical Engineering, Aug, 2013 T14045 -RB1 T. S. Rajan, Automobile Engineering, 12th Edition T14045–RB2 Dr. Kripal Singh A Course in Thermal Engineering Reprint T14045–RB3 V. M. Domkundwar Fluid Mechanics & Hydraulic Machine, Ninth, 2010 T14045–RB4 R. K. Bansal 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! 978-81-224-1172-0 New Age International (P) Ltd. Standard Publishers Distributers Dhanpat Rai & Co (p) Ltd 978-81-318-0815-3 Laxmi Publication Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 76 T14045 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14045-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 77 T14046: TRANSFORMERS, DC AND AC MACHINES PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14046 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 120 120 100 P Transformers, DC and AC Machines Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘2 online SCORM lectures’ at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘2 face-to-face lectures (each of 45 minutes duration) at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each Term-Work or Practical session shall be of 240 minutes duration. Remaining time of 195 minutes after initial lectures of 45 minutes shall be used for actual conduct and reporting of Term-work/practical activities during each session. Evaluation Pattern: In total evaluation, Internal Examiner (IE) and External Examiner (EE) shall have 50% weightage. Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA) (Only by IE): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by EE): 20 Marks b. Actual Conduct of Practical by the student: 20 Marks (by EE) + 20 Marks (by IE) c. Viva on Practical Report/Activity: 10 Marks (by EE) + 10 Marks (by IE) PART I: TRANSFORMERS AND DC MACHINES PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Explore the concepts of DC machines and transformers Analyze and test the characteristics of DC machines and transformers Handle and operate various Electric Machines DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY Credit Block UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Course Content Covered in T14042: Transformers and DC Machines Credit 01 02 Course Content Covered in T14042: Transformers and DC Machines Credit 02 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity [Perform Any 5 Activities from each Credit) 01 a) To Study and Identify Different Parts of D. C Machine b) Using Resistance Measurement method Identify Different Windings of D. C Machine 02 To Study the Torque Vs. Speed Characteristics of Shunt Wound, Series, and Compound DC Motors 03 To Calculate the Efficiency of Shunt Wound, Series, and Compound DC Motors 04 To Obtain Speed Control of DC Shunt Motor by Flux Control and Armature Resistance Control 05 To Perform Load Test on DC Shunt Motor and Find Efficiency 06 To Find Open Circuit Characteristics of Self Excited DC Shunt Generator and Obtain its Critical Resistance 07 To Obtain the Load Characteristics of DC Compound Generator under Cumulative and Differential Mode Condition Credit Block Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 01 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 78 08 To Conduct Open Circuit and Short Circuit Test on Single Phase Transformer 09 To Conduct load test on single phase transformer and to find efficiency and regulation 10 To Determine Transformation Ratio, percentage Regulation and Efficiency of Single Phase Transformer by Direct Loading. 11 12 13 14 To Determine the Efficiency and Regulation of a Transformer by Conducting Open Circuit Test and Short Circuit Test and to Draw Equivalent Circuit To Determine the Phase Sequence of a Three Phase Power Line and Its Effect on Three Phase Induction Motor Operation To Separate the Eddy Current Loss and Hysteresis Loss from the Iron Loss of Single Phase Transformer Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 02 To determine the relationship between line voltages & phase voltages by Connecting 3-phase transformer in Δ-Δ, y-Δ, y-y & Δ-y LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Edition Year Title Author ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14046-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14046-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14042-RB1 DC Machines and Transformers, K Murugesh Kumar 2nd 2004 9788125916055, Vikas Publishing House Pvt Ltd T14042-RB2 Electric Machines, D.P. Kothari, I Nagrath 4th 2010 9780070699670, McGraw-Hill Education, India. T14042-RB3 Principle of Electrical Machines, V.K. Mehta, Rohit Mehta Reprint 2006 8121921910, 9788121921916, S. Chand T14042-RB4 Electrical Machines: Theory And Practice, M. N. Bando 2007 812032997X, 9788120329973 PHI Learning Pvt. Ltd., 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14046-CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14046-WL1 PART II: AC MACHINES RESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND L EARNING O BJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Explore the concepts of 1-ф induction motor, 3-ф induction motor and 3-ф Alternator Analyze and test the characteristics of AC machines Handle and operate various Electric Machines DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Credit Block 01 Course Content Covered in T14043: AC Machines Credit 01 02 Course Content Covered in T14043: AC Machines Credit 02 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 79 Credit Block UN Name of the Practical Activity Perform any seven (7) activities 01 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units Start the Induction Motor by using Direct Online Starter and Reverse the Direction of Rotation using Reversible Switch 02 Start the Induction Motor by using Star- Delta Starting Method 03 Draw the equivalent circuit of the Single Phase Induction Motor by conducting (a) No-load Test (b) Blocked Rotor Test 04 To Perform the brake test on a 3-ф Slip Ring Induction Motor and obtain its performance characteristics 05 Questions Credit 01 To Control the speed of 3-ф Induction Motor by i) Rotor Resistance Variation ii) Variable Frequency Supply to Stator 06 To Measure the slip of 3-ф induction motor using i) Tachometer ii) Stroboscope 07 To Control the Speed of Induction Motor by Frequency Changing/ Cascade Method Or Pole-Changing Method Perform any seven (7) activities Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units 08 To Determine Torque, Output, Efficiency, Power Factor by conducting Load test on Induction motor 09 To Determine the Regulation of an Alternator at Full Load At Different Power Factors using i) Synchronous Impedance and ii) MMF Methods 10 To Determine Voltage Regulation of 3-ф Alternator by Direct Loading Test for Different Power Factor 11 To Start a 3- ф Slip Ring Induction Motor by Rotor Resistance Starter. Credit 02 12 To Synchronize 3-ф Alternators with Bus-Bar 13 To Synchronize 3-ф alternator by i) Three Lamp Method ii) Synchroscope To Study the effect of Capacitor on the Starting and Running of a Single-Phase Induction Motor, 14 both in Starting and Running Condition and to Determine the method of Reversing the Direction of Rotation LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14046-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14046-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Electrical Machines 3rd 007066921X, 9780070669215 T14043 –RB1 S. K. Bhattacharya 2008 Aug Tata McGraw - Hill Education, New Delhi Induction and Synchronous Machines 1st 9788125909262 T14043 –RB2 K Murugesh Kumar 2000 Vikas publication House Pvt.Ltd T14043 –RB3 Electrical Machines Vol-II K Murugesh Kumar 1st 2010 A Textbook of Electrical Technology: Volume II: AC & DC Machines 23rd Theraja & A.K. Theraja Revised Ed 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14046 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14046-WL1 T14043 –RB4 9788125939474 Vikas publication House Pvt.Ltd 8121924375 / 9788121924375 S. Chand & Company Ltd. Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 80 SEMESTER 05 T14051: INDUSTRY ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14051 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Industry Electrical Systems Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand the Operation and Control of Various Electrical Drives, Electrical Furnaces, Electrical Welding Equipments Explain the Importance of Power Factor, Utilization of Electrical Energy, Energy Conservation and Good Illumination Explain the various Components in Electric Traction System Teaching Learning of Part I (Industry Electrical Systems) of Term work Course T14055 UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 Electrical Drive System Elevators Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 03 04 Electric Heating Electric Welding Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 05 06 07 Illumination Tariff Power Factor Improvement Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Electric Traction Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 08 DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit Block Page 81 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 Electrical Drive System: Concept of Drive and its Advantages and Disadvantages, Factors Governing Selection of Motors, Types of Drive, Selection of Motor-Nature of Mechanical Load ; Matching of speed Torque Characteristic of Load and Motor; Starting Condition of the Load, Electrical Characteristic of DC and AC Motor, Brief Introduction of Different Methods of Starting Gear of the Motors, Methods of Speed Control, Requirement of Electrical Braking, Disadvantages of Electric Braking over Mechanical Breaking, Types of Electric BrakingPlugging or Reverse Current Braking; Rheostatic Braking or Dynamic Braking; Regenerative Braking, Mechanical Features of Drives -Types of Enclosure and Bearing, Types of Transmission of Drive- Flat Belt Drive; V Belt Drive; Rope Drive; Toothed Belt Drive; Chain Drive; Gear Drive; Direct Drive, Noise Level, Load Cycles - Continuous loading, Short time loading, Long time ( Intermittent) Loading, Continuous Credit 01 operations short time loading, Continuous operations long time loading: Concept with graphical representation, Derivation of the Power of Motor Elevators : Ideal Requirements of the Elevator System, Function of Elevator, Applications of Elevators, Types of Elevators, Factors for Selection of Elevator, Shape and Size of Car of Elevator, Speed of Elevators, Location of Elevator Machine, Types of Elevator MachineDrum and Traction Elevator, Elevator Motors, Safety Precautions, Bombay Lift Act Electric Heating: Methods of Heat Transfer, Advantages of Electric Heating, Classification of Heating Methods, Resistance Heating- Direct Resistance Heating; Indirect Resistance Heating; Requirement of Good Heating Material; Causes of Failure of Heating Elements, Electric ARC Heating, Induction Heating- Various Types of Induction Furnaces; Core Type Furnace; Ajax Wyatt Vertical Core Furnaces; Tama Furnace; and its Advantages, High Frequency Eddy Current Heating- Working Principle; Advantages and Application of Eddy Current Heating, Dielectric Heating-Dielectric Loss; Dielectric Heating and Applications of Dielectric Heating, Design of Heating Element, Temperature Control of Resistance Furnaces – i)By Varying the Applied Voltages To Elements ii)By Varying the Resistance of the Element Credit iii)Periodically Switching on and off the Electric Supply, Temperature Control of Induction Furnaces, Methods of Obtaining of Power Supply 02 for Induction Furnaces Electric Welding: Meaning and Advantages of Electric Welding, Types of Electric Welding, Electric Resistance Welding- Types of Resistance Welding; Spot Welding; Spot Welding Machine, Electric Arc Welding- Polarity in D.C Welding; Electrodes for Arc Welding; Carbon Arc Welding; Metal Arc Welding, Comparison between D.C Welding, A.C Welding, Spot Welding and Resistance Welding, Electric Supply for Arc Welding (V-I Characteristics of Arc), Arc Welding Machines - D.C Welding Set, Arc Welding Machines - A.C Welding Set – i)Tapped Reactor ii)Moving Coil Method iii)Magnetic Shunt Method, Requirements of Good Weld Illumination: Important Terms Related with Illumination, Laws of Illumination-Inverse Square Law and Lambert’s Cosine Law, Sources of Light with Working Principle, Construction, Operation and Application of - Incandescent or Filament Lamp; Fluorescent Tube; Mercury Vapour Lamp; Sodium Vapour Lamp; Compact Fluorescent Lamp (C.F.L.); LED Lamp; Metal Halide Lamp and Halogen Lamp, Basic Principles of Light Control- Specular and Diffuse Reflection, Types of Lighting Scheme- i)Direct ii)Semi Direct iii) Indirect iv)Semi- Indirect v) General Lighting Scheme, Design of Lighting Scheme - Objectives and Factors to be Considered While Designing of Lighting Schemes, General Requirements and Types of Installations of Factory Lighting, Method of Lighting Calculation Credit Tariff : Meaning of Term Tariff, Objectives and Requirements of Tariff , Types of Tariff –Block Rate Tariff; KVA Maximum Demand Tariff 03 Time of Day Metering / Tariff, Introduction to Four Quadrant Metering [Simple Numerical based on content Covered] Power Factor Improvement : Concept of Power Factor and Power Triangle, Disadvantages of Low Power Factor, Causes of Low Power Factor, Principle of Power Factor Improvement, Power Factor Improvement Equipments -Static Capacitors; Synchronous Condensers; Phase Advancers, Most Economical Power Factor with Derivation, Location of Power Factor Correction Equipment, Avoidance of Low Power factor without using P.F. improving Apparatus , Limitations of Static Capacitors in Improving P.F. of Drives run by Inverters or VFDs Electric Traction: Requirement of Ideal Traction System, Non-electric Traction System, Electric Drive and its Advantages and Disadvantages, Track Electrification System- Direct Current System; Composite System; Advantages of 25 kV A.C. System Over D.C System; Comparison between Pure A.C and D.C System; Block Diagram of A.C Electric Locomotive, Traction Mechanics -Types of Services, SpeedTime Curve, Average Speed and Schedule Speed, Power of Traction Motor, Specific Energy Consumption, Factors Affecting i)Specific Energy Consumption ii)Coefficient of Adhesion, Traction Motors -Desirable Characteristics of Traction Motors, Suitability of Series Motor Credit 04 for Traction Duty and Suitability of Three Phase Induction Motors for Traction Duty, Traction Motor Control- Series Parallel Control of D.C Series Motor; Shunt Transition; Bridge Transition; Thyristor Control Method, Traction Control System of A.C Locomotives – Tap Changing Method LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14051-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14051-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Utilization of Electric Power & Electric Traction 2012 edition 9350142589, 978-9350142585 T14051 –RB1 J.B.Gupta (2013) S.K. Kataria & Sons Utilisation of Electric Power: Including Electric Drives &Electric 2nd 978-81-224-3681-5 Traction, T14051 –RB2 2014 New Age International Suryanarayana, N.V T14051 –RB3 Generation & Utilization of Electrical Energy, 2010 978-81-317-3332-5 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 82 S.Sivanagaraju, M.Balasubba Reddy, D.Srilatha Principals of Power System, Reprint V.K.Mehta & Rohit Mehta 2006 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14051 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14051-WL1 T14051 –RB4 Pearson 81-219-2496-0 S.Chand Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 83 T14052: MICROCONTROLLER PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14052 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Microcontroller Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand concept and need of microprocessor and microcontroller Explain internal architecture details of PIC microcontroller Understand how to Interface peripherals to microcontroller Understand and apply the programming techniques Understand various application of PIC Microcontroller UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 History and Features of The PIC Microcontrollers PIC Architecture and Assembly Language programming Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 03 04 05 Branch , Call and Time delay Loop PIC I/O Port Programming Arithmetic, Logic Instructions and Programs Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 06 07 08 PIC Programming in C PIC18 Timer Programming in C PIC18 Serial port programming in C Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 09 10 11 12 Interrupt programming in C LCD and Keyboard Interfacing ADC, DAC and Sensor Interface Motor Control: Relay, PWM, DC and Stepper Motor Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Credit Block 01 History and Features of The PIC Microcontrollers : Microcontrollers and Embedded Processors, Overview of the PIC18 Family, Comparison with 8051 Microcontroller 02 PIC Architecture and Assembly Language programming: Concept of John Von Neumann’s Architectures and Harvard Architectures, Credit The WREG Register in the PIC, The PIC File Register, Using Instructions with the Default Access Bank, PIC Status Register, PIC Data Format 01 and Directives, Introduction to PIC Assembly Programming, Assembling and Linking a PIC Program, The Program Counter and Program ROM Space in the PIC, RISC Architecture in the PIC, Viewing Register and Memory with MPLAB Simulator Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 84 03 Branch, Call and Time delay Loop: BRANCH Instructions and Looping, CALL Instructions and Stack, PIC18 Time Delay and Instruction Credit Pipeline 02 04 PIC I/O Port Programming: I/O Port programming in PIC18, I/O Bit Manipulation Programming 05 Arithmetic, Logic Instructions and Programs: Arithmetic Instructions, Signed Number Concepts and Arithmetic Operations, Logic and Compare Instructions, Rotate Instruction and Data Serialization, BCD and ASCII Conversion 06 07 08 PIC Programming in C: Data Types and Time Delays in C, I/O Programming in C, Logic Operations in C, Data Conversion Programs in C, Data Serialization in C, Program ROM Allocation in C18, Data RAM Allocation in C18 PIC18 Timer Programming in C : Programming Timers 0 and 1, Counter Programming, Programming Timers 0 and 1 in C, Programming Timers 2 and 3 PIC18 Serial port programming in C: Basics of Serial Communication, PIC18 Connection to RS232, PIC18 Serial Port Programming in C Credit 03 09 Interrupt programming in C: PIC18 Interrupts, Programming Timer Interrupts, Programming External Hardware Interrupts, Programming the Serial Communication Interrupt, PortB Change Interrupt, Interrupt priority in the PIC18 10 LCD and Keyboard Interfacing: LCD Interfacing, Keyboard Interfacing 11 ADC, DAC and Sensor Interface: ADC Characteristics, ADC Programming in the PIC18, DAC Interfacing, Sensor Interfacing and Signal Conditioning 12 Motor Control: Relay, PWM, DC and Stepper Motor: Relays and Optoisolators, Stepper Motor Interfacing, DC Motor Interfacing and Credit PWM, PWM Motor Control with CCP, DC motor Control with ECCP 04 LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14052-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14052-TB1 PIC Microcontroller and Embedded Systems using Assembly and c for 15th 9788131716755, 9788131716755 PIC18, Impression Pearson Education Muhammad Ali Mazidi, Rolind D Mckinlay, Danny Causey 2014 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! PIC Microcontrollers - Programming in C, 978-86-84417-17-8 T14052 –RB1 Milan Verle mikroElektronika; 1st edition (2009) T14052 –RB2 T14052 –RB3 T14052 –RB4 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14052 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14052-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 85 T14053: POWER ELECTRONICS PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14053 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Power Electronics Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand Operating principles used in Power Electronics Devices Explain Construction and Operation of Controlled Rectifiers, Choppers, Inverter and Industrial Control Circuits Describe the Applications of Power Devices in Industrial Electronics, UPS and SMPS UNITS UN Name of the Unit 01 02 Power Electronics Thyristor Family Devices 03 04 Triggering Devices and Turn ON Methods of SCR Turn OFF Methods of SCR 05 06 Phase Controlled Rectifiers Polyphase Rectifiers 07 08 Converters Industrial Control Circuits CSs Questions Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit Block Page 86 01 Power Electronics: Introduction to Power Electronics- Principle and Application Area, Need of High Power Semiconductor Switches, General Requirements of Power Devices, Need of Power Transistor, MOSFET and IGBT, Introduction to Power Transistors -Classification of Power Transistors, Construction and Principle of Operation of Power BJT; I-V Characteristics of the Power Transistor- Operation; how differ from Small Signal BJT?; Quasi Saturation and Hard Saturation in Power Transistors, Various Losses in Power Devices, Switching Characteristics of a Power BJT, Turn on Characteristics; Turn Off Characteristics; Charge Profile during Turn –off, Second Breakdown in Power Transistors, Merits, Demerits and Applications of a Power BJT, Power MOSFET- Construction; Principle of Operation and I-V Characteristics of Power MOSFET; Switching Characteristics of Power MOSFET, Forward Blocking Capacity of a Power MOSFET, Merits, Demerits and Applications of Power MOSFET, Insulated Gate Bipolar Transistor (IGBT)- Concept; Features; Basic Structure; I-V Characteristics of IGBT, Types of IGBTs - Non Punch Credit 01 Through IGBT and Punch Through IGBT, Principle of Operation of IGBT, Merits, Demerits and Applications of IGBT 02 Thyristor Family Devices: Introduction to Thyristor Family Devices- Applications of Thyristor; Silicon Controlled Rectifier and its Important Features; Construction and I-V Characteristics of SCR; Two Transistor Analogy of SCR; SCR as a Switch; Merits, Demerits, Applications and Specifications of SCR, Types of SCR- Phase Control SCRs and Fast Switching SCRs, Triacs - Construction; I-V Characteristics and Different states of Triac Operation, Modes of Operations- Operating Modes; Advantages; Disadvantages; Applications and Specifications of a Triac, Light Activated SCR (LASCR)- Equivalent Circuit of LASCR; VI Characteristics ; Advantages and Applications of LASCR, Comparison of Power Devices 03 04 Triggering Devices and Turn ON Methods of SCR: Triggering Devices: Ideal Switch Characteristics, Triggering Devices, DIAC – Construction; Applications and Disadvantages of DIAC, Comparisons of i)Diac and Triac Turn ON Methods of SCR : Introduction to Turn On Methods, Delay Angle or Firing Angle or Phase Angle (α), Turn ON Methods- Thermal Triggering; Illumination Triggering; Forward Voltage Triggering; dv/dt Triggering and Gate Triggering, Dynamic Characteristics of SCR- Turn ON Characteristics of SCR, Static Losses and Switching Losses in Power Devices, SCR Gate Characteristics - Types of Gate Triggering; Pulsed Triggering of SCR; Requirement of Gate Drive for SCR, Triggering Circuits - Gate Triggering Circuit; Requirements Firing Circuit; Half Wave RC (Capacitance ) Firing Circuit; Full Wave RC (Capacitance ) Firing Circuit; Basic UJT Relaxation Oscillator; SCR Triggering using UJT; Pulse Credit Transformers; Pulse Amplifier Circuit; Gate Protection Circuit; Comparison of Triggering Circuit; SCR Triggering using PUT 02 Turn OFF Methods of SCR: Introduction to Turn off Methods - Turn Off Process, Turn Off Characteristics of SCR and Turn off Time (tq), Concept of Commutation, Commutation Techniques- Natural and Forced Commutation, Conditions for Successful Commutation, Classification of Forced Commutation Methods , Self-Commutation by Resonating the Load (Class A)- Load in Parallel with Capacitor; Load in Series with the SCR; Drawbacks of Self Commutation Technique, Class B – Self Commutated by an LC Circuit; Complementary Voltage Commutation (Class C Commutation )- Operation , Value of the Commutating Capacitor C, Modified Complementary Commutated Circuit Auxiliary Voltage Commutation (Class D Commutation), Comparison between i) Natural and Forced Commutation ii) Voltage Commutation and Current Commutation, iii) Self and Class D Commutation 05 Phase Controlled Rectifiers: Introduction to Phase Controlled Rectifiers - Concept of Firing Angle α and conduction angle Ø, Classification of Controlled Rectifiers, Single Phase Half wave Controlled Rectifier(HWCR) - Operation and Analysis with Resistive Load and Inductive (RL) Load; Effect of Freewheeling Diode in Controlled Rectifiers; Average Output Voltage of HWCR with RL Load; Rectifier Operation (Single Quadrant Operation) and Drawbacks of HWCR, Semiconverter or Half Controlled Bridge (Full Wave ) - Operation with Highly Inductive (RL)Load; Variation of Average Load Voltage with Single Quadrant Operation; Half Controlled Converter with Freewheeling Diode (RL load); Operation with the Resistive Load (Symmetrical Configuration); Asymmetrical Configuration Operation (Half Credit Controlled Converter); Comparison between Configurations of Semiconverter; Advantages and Disadvantages of Semiconverters, 03 Application, Phase Full Wave Controlled Rectifier -Mid-point Configuration; Operation with Resistive Load and Highly Inductive Load, Full Converter or Bridge Rectifier- Operation of Full Converter with RL Load; Two Quadrant Operation of Full Converter (Rectifier and Inverter Modes); Operation of Full Converter with Resistive Load, Bridge Configuration using Freewheeling Diode – Advantages; Disadvantages and Application of Full Converter; Applications of Controlled Rectifiers; Comparison of Controlled HWR and Controlled FWR [No derivation of formula is expected in this unit, Drawing of output waveforms in the end examination is not expected] 06 Polyphase Rectifiers – Need and Advantages of Polyphase Rectifiers; 3-phase Transformers ; Concepts of the Three phase Supply; Types of polyphase Rectifiers, 3 Phase Halfwave Delta_Wye Rectifier- Operation with Inductive Load; Diode Currents with Resistive Load; Performance parameters; Drawbacks of 3 phase Halfwave Rectifier, 3-phase Half wave Controlled Rectifier (HWCR)(three pulse Converter)- Operation with RL (Inductive) Load and purely Resistive Load, Applications of polyphase Rectifiers [No derivation of formula is expected, Drawing of output waveforms in the end examination is not expected] 07 08 Converters: Basic circuit and Operation of Choppers Using MOSFET, Classification of Choppers, Control Strategies of Choppers - Pulse Width Modulation (PWM); Constant Pulse Width Variable Frequency; Variable Pulse Width and Frequency; Step Down ChopperPrinciple, Analysis; Basic Circuit and Operation Using MOSFET Chopper, Step Up Chopper- Expression for the Output Voltage and Step up Chopper using MOSFET, Applications of a Chopper, Comparison of Step up and step Down Chopper, Concept of Inverter, Classification of Inverter Based on the i)Nature of Source ii) Configuration of the Inverter iii) Nature of Output Waveform iv) Types of Commutation Circuit v) Power Semiconductor Device Used, Half Bridge Inverter - Operation with Resistive Load and with Inductive Load, Performance Parameters of Inverters - Harmonic Factor of nth Harmonics HFn; Total Harmonic Distortion (THD); Distortion Factor DF; Lowest Order Credit 04 Harmonic LOH; Cross Conduction or Shoot through Fault, Inverter Specifications, Applications of Inverters Industrial Control Circuits: AC Power Flasher, Triac Control using Diac (AC phase Control )- Light Dimmer using Triac and Fan Regulator using Triac, Simple Battery Charger with Battery Charging Regulator, Switch Mode Power Supply (SMPS)- Block Diagram; Complete Switched Mode Regulator; Classification of SMPS; Types of Nonisolated Switching Regulators; Advantages, Disadvantages and Application of SMPS, UPS- Need of UPS; Types of UPS; On Line UPS (Inverter Preferred ) or (Continuous) Off Line UPS (Line Preferred ) or Transfer UPS System , Applications of UPS, Variable Frequency Drives- Concept, Operation and its Applications LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 87 1. 2. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14053-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14033-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! nd Power Electronics, 2 Ed, T14053 –RB1 M D Singh and K B Khanchandani 2006 Power Electronics: Principle & Applications, 1st Ed, T14053 –RB2 Vithayathil 2010 Power Electronics: Circuits, Devices and Applications, 4th Ed, T14053 –RB3 Muhammad H. Rashid 2013 1st Ed, Fundamentals of Power Electronics, T14053 –RB4 S. K. Bhattacharya 2005 Industrial and Power Electronics, 10th Ed, T14053 –RB5 Harish C. Rai reprint 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14053 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14053-WL1 9780070583894 McGraw-Hill 9780070702394 Tata McGraw-Hill 0133125904, 978-0133125900, Prentice Hall of India 9788125918530, Vikas Publishing House 8188114146 , 9788188114146 Umesh Publications Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 88 T14054: ELECTRICAL POWER TRANSMISSION AND DISTRIBUTION PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14054 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Electrical Power Transmission and Distribution Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Explain Concept of Distributed R, L & C for Transmission Line and Extra High Voltage Transmission Identify the Main Components of Transmission and Distribution Line Determine Performance of the Line Based on Efficiency and Regulation and Performance of Distributer with given Parameters UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 Basics of Transmissions Transmission Line Components Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 03 04 Transmission Line Parameters Performance of Transmission Line Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 05 06 Extra High Voltage Transmission A.C Distribution System Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 07 Primary and Secondary Distribution Sub Station Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Basics of Transmissions: Introduction to Power System with Block Diagram, Typical Layout of Power System Types of Electricity Transmission System, Classification of Transmission Line, Need of EHV Transmission Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit Block Credit 01 Page 89 02 Transmission Line Components: Components in Transmission Line, Line Conductors- Stranded and Bundled Conductors, Classification and Construction of Cable- Low Tension Cables; High Tension (H.T.) Cables; Super Tension Cable and Extra High Tension Cables, Cable LayingDirect Laying; Draw in System; Solid System, Cable Joining, Line Supports- Properties of Insulators; Steel Poles; R.C.C (Reinforced Cement Concrete)/ PSC( Pre-stressed Concrete) Poles; Steel Towers; Rolled Steel joist (RSI) poles, Erection of Transmission Lines - Construction Practice of Transmission Lines such as Survey of the Proposed Route; Pole Locations; Erection of Poles and Concreting; Erection of DP Structure, Fixing of Cross-Arms and Top-brackets, Insulators and Bindings, Tying of Conductor on Pin Insulators, Conductor Erection Paving and Jointing, Properties and Types of Line Insulators, Failure of Insulator, Distribution of Potential over a String of Suspension Insulator with Mathematical Expression, String Efficiency, Methods of Improving String Efficiency, Spacing between Conductors, Span Lengths, SagCalculation of Sag; Supports are at Equal Ground Level; Supports are at Unequal Level; Effect of Wind and Ice Loading on Sag Calculation; Sag Template and Stringing Chart [Simple Numerical Based on content Covered] 03 Transmission Line Parameters: Introduction to Transmission Line Constants, Effect of these Parameters on Efficiency and Regulation of Transmission Line, Various Effects in Transmission Line - Skin Effect; Proximity Effect and Ferranti Effect, Transposition of Conductors, Corona- Formation of Corona; Advantages and Disadvantages of Corona; Factors Affecting the Corona; Important Terms Related with Corona; Methods of Reducing Corona; Electromagnetic Interference and Electrostatic Interference Due to Corona 04 Performance of Transmission Line: Classification of Transmission Line, Efficiency and Regulation of Transmission Line, Analysis of Short Transmission Line, Effect of Load Power Factor on Performance of Transmission Line, Analysis of Medium Transmission Line- Nominal ‘T’ Method; Nominal ‘π (pi)' Method; End Condenser Method, Long Transmission Line, Generalized Constants of Transmission Line- Short Transmission Line; Medium Transmission Line (Nominal ‘T' Method); Medium Transmission Line (Nominal ‘π (pi)' Method); Long Transmission Lines [Simple Numerical Based on content Covered] 05 06 07 Credit 02 Extra High Voltage Transmission: Introduction and Definition of EHV, Necessity and Importance of EHV Transmission, Limitations of EHV Transmission, EHVAC Transmission System, EHVDC Transmission System, Layout of H.V.D.C. Links- Monopolar H.V.D.C. Link; Bipolar H.V.D.C. Link; Homopolar H.V.D.C. Link, Incorporation of H.V.D.C. link into AC System-Two Terminal DC Link for Point to Point Transmission; Long Distance High Power Transmission; Under Water Transmission; DC Link in Parallel with AC Link; H.V.D.C Back to Back System, HVDC Line in Credit Maharashtra 03 A.C Distribution System: Components of Distribution System, Classification of Distribution System- According to Nature of Supply such as A.C. distribution and D.C. distribution system; According to Type of Construction; According to Method of Connection, Requirements of Good Distribution System, Design Considerations, A. C. Distribution Calculations [Simple Numerical Based on content Covered] Primary and Secondary Distribution Sub Station: Types of Substations according to Service Requirement and Constructional Features, Comparison between Indoor and Outdoor Substation, Selection of Site for Substation, Symbols used for Equipment’s in Substation, Equipment used in Substation- i) Circuit Breaker- Arc Formation Process; Methods of Arc Extinction; High Resistance Method (Blow out Coils); Splitting of the Arc; Cooling of the Arc; Low Resistance or Zero Point Extinction; Concept of Arc Voltage; Re-striking Voltage and Recovery Voltage, Classification of Circuit Breakers; Air Break Circuit Breaker, Oil Circuit Breaker and Minimum Oil Circuit Breaker ii) Isolator AB Switches, iii) Transformer- Construction of Three Phase Transformers; Types of Three Phase Transformer; Three-Phase Transformer Connections; Star-Star Connection; Delta-Delta Connection; Delta-Star Connection; Star-Delta Transformer, iv) Fuses - Semi Enclosed or Rewirable Fuse; D-Type Cartridge Fuse; Link Type Fuses; Expulsion Type High Voltage Fuses; Dropout Fuses or Dropdown Credit Fuses; Striker Fuse; High Rupturing Capacity Fuses; Desirable Characteristics of Fuse Element ; Fuse Characteristics, v) Introduction to 04 Lightening Arresters- Causes of Over voltages; Lightening Arresters; Types of Lightening Arresters; Rod Gap Arrester; Horn Gap Arrester; Expulsion Type Arrester; Valve Type Arrester (or Thynite Type Arrester), vi) Microprocessor Based Protective Relays with their Advantages and Special Features - Protective Transformers; Current Transformers; Burden on CT; Magnetization Curve of CT; Voltage Transformer; Burdens on Voltage Transform; Types of Construction of VT’s, vii)Introduction of Relay - Functions of Protective Relaying and Basic Connection of Trip Circuit, Sequence of Operation among Circuit Breaker. Isolator and Earthing Switch, Types of Bus Bar and Arrangements of Bus Bar in a Substation, Control Room, Control Panel, Cross Bracing, Guarding, Anti-climbing Devices, Distribution Box, Substation Earthing System, Functions of Substation Earthing System, Step Potential and Touch Potential, Layout of Substation, Concept of AutoReclosures, Introduction to Gas Insulated Substation(GIS) LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14054-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14054-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Principals of Power System, Reprint 81-219-2496-0 T14054 –RB1 V.K.Mehta & Rohit Mehta 2006 S.Chand Electrical Power Distribution System, 4 August 0070151415, 978-0070151413 T14054 –RB2 V. Kamaraju 2009 McGraw Hill Education (India) Private Ltd Electric Power Transmission and Distribution, 9788131707913 T14054 –RB3 2009 S.Sivanagaraju, S.Satyanarayana Pearson Education India T14054 –RB4 Electric Power Generation: Transmission And Distribution 2nd 9788120335608 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 90 S. N. Singh 2011 Transmission & Distribution of Electrical Power 2013 J.B. Gupta 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14054 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14054-WL1 T14054 –RB5 PHP Learning 8185749574, 978-9350143629 S.K. Kataria & Sons Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 91 T14055: INDUSTRY ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS AND ENERGY CONSERVATION & AUDIT PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14055 Course Name Industry Electrical Systems and Energy Conservation & Audit Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 120 120 100 TW Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘2 online SCORM lectures’ at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘2 face-to-face lectures (each of 45 minutes duration) at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each Term-Work or Practical session shall be of 240 minutes duration. Remaining time of 195 minutes after initial lectures of 45 minutes shall be used for actual conduct and reporting of Term-work/practical activities during each session. Evaluation Pattern: In total evaluation, Internal Examiner (IE) and External Examiner (EE) shall have 50% weightage. Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA) (Only by IE): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by EE): 20 Marks b. Viva on Term-Work Submission by the student: 30 Marks (by EE) + 30 Marks (by IE) PART I: INDUSTRY ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Perform Testing of Electrical Installation and Evaluation Select Appropriate Rating of Accessories required for Installation Analyse and Select Appropriate Methods for Estimation and Costing DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Credit Block Drawing and I.E Rules: Classification and Requirements of Electrical Installation, List of Symbols, Classification of Drawings, Definitions, I.E. Rules, standards and Certifications Related to Electrical Installation and Testing Service Connection: Components of Distribution System, Classification of Distribution System, Service Connection and its Types, Service 02 Mains, Difference between Overhead and Underground Service Connection, Material Required for Underground Service Credit 01 Electrification of Residential Installation: Guidelines for Wiring of Residential Installation, Positioning of Equipments, Principles of Circuit Design in Lighting and Power Circuits, Procedure for Designing the Circuits, Method of Drawing Electrical Diagrams, Selection of Types of 03 Wiring, Load Calculation and Selection of Size of Conductor, Selection of Rating of Main Switch and Protective Switch Gear, Earthing of Residential Installation, Earthing of Domestic Appliances, Sequence to be Followed for Preparing Estimate 01 Electrification of Commercial Installation: Power Distribution Arrangement, Fundamental Consideration of Planning of an Electrical 04 Installation System for Commercial Building, Design Consideration of Electrical Installation System for Commercial Building, Sequence to be Followed to Prepare Estimation Electrification of Industrial Installation: Concept of Motor Wiring Circuit , Important Guidelines about Power Wiring and Motor Wiring, 05 Design Consideration, Sequence to be Followed to Prepare Estimation, Equipments Used for Measurement of High Resistance, Control Panel Wiring, Testing of Installation Credit Contracts, Tenders and Execution: Contract, Essential Requirement of Valid Contract , Types of Engineering Contract , Criteria for Selecting 02 Contractor and Supplier, Tender, Classification of Tender or Invitation of Tender, Tender Notice, Step by Step Procedure Followed by 06 Contractor in Preparing Tender Document, Procedure of Submission of Tender Document, Procedure of Opening Tendering Document, Technical Sanctions, Payment to Contractor or Supplier , Measurement and Validation Protocol DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 92 Credit Block UN Name of the Practical Activity 01 Prepare Detailed Electrical Estimation with Wiring Diagram for Residential Consumers Like Small Bungalow or House 02 Read and Interpret Detailed Electrical Estimation with Wiring Diagram for any one of the Commercial Consumers : Malls, Banks 03 Read and Interpret Detailed Electrical Estimation with Wiring Diagram for any one of the Commercial Consumers: Hospitals, Commercial Complex 04 Prepare Detailed Electrical Estimation for Agricultural consumer: Jet Pump 05 Prepare Detailed Electrical Estimation for Agricultural consumers Submersible Pump 06 Prepare Detailed Electrical Estimation with Wiring Diagram for Commercial Building or Floor Mill 07 Read and Interpret Detailed Electrical Estimation for Small and Medium Industrial Consumers. Draw Single Line Diagram and Circuit Diagram 08 Prepare Detailed Electrical Installation and layout preparation of College Campus. 09 Prepare Detailed Electrical Installation and layout preparation of Factory or Workshop 10 Prepare i) Tender Documents ii) Billing following Appropriate Procedure on any of the topic Credit 01 Credit 02 Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Edition Year Title Author ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14055-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14055-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14055 -RB1 A Course in Electrical Installation, Estimating & Costing J.B.Gupta Reprint 2015 9789350142790 S K Kataria & Sons T14055–RB2 Electrical Design Estimating and Costing K.B.Raina S.K.Bhattacharya First Reprint 2014 81-224-0363-8 New Age International T14055–RB3 Electrical Wiring Estimating and Costing S.L.UPPAL , G.C GARG 6th 9788174092403 Khanna Publishers Delhi T14055–RB4 T14055–RB5 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14055 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14055-WL1 T14055-WL2 PART II: ENERGY CONSERVATION & AUDIT PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Calculate Energy Use and Analyze How Changing Their Behaviors and Appliances will affect the Energy their use Describe Methods of Energy Audit Select Proper Energy Conservation Equipment as per the Application holder in Business Environment Work as Energy Manager after passing BEE Examination DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit Block Page 93 01 02 03 04 Energy Conservation: Need of Energy Conservation, Energy Conservation Act-2001, Functions of Government Organizations such as National Productivity Councils (NPC), Ministry of New and Renewable Energy (MNRE), Functions of BEE, Maharashtra Energy Development Agency (MEDA) Energy Conservation in Lighting System: Introduction to Illumination System-Terminology, Recommended Luminance Levels, Purpose and Pre Measurement Preparation for Assessing the Existing Lighting System, Energy Conservation Techniques in Lighting System- By Replacing Lamp Sources such as Compact Fluorescent Lamps (CFL), High Intensity Discharge (HID) Lamps, Light Emitting Diode (LED), Using Energy Efficient Luminaires Fitting, Using Light Control Gears, By installation of Separate Transformer / Servo Stabilizer for Lighting, Periodic Survey and Adequate Maintenance Program - Re-Lamping and Cleaning with their Advantages, Energy Conservation Techniques in Fan, Electronic Regulator Credit 01 Energy Conservation Techniques in Electrical Motor : Necessity of Energy Conservation in Electrical Motor, Various Energy Conservation Techniques in Induction Motor- Improving Power Quality; Motor Survey; Matching Motor; Minimizing Idle and Redundant Running of Motor; Operating in Star Mode; Rewinding of Motor; Improving Mechanical Power and Transmission Efficiency, Energy Efficient Motors Comparison of Conventional Motors with Energy Efficient Motors; Energy Saving Estimation Energy Conservation in Transmission and Distribution System: Energy Conservation Techniques in Transmission and Distribution System- i) Related to Technical Losses - By Reducing I2R Losses; By Compensating Reactive Power Flow; System Voltage Optimization and Phase Current Balancing; By using Energy Efficient Transformer, ii) Related to Commercial Losses - Mitigation of Power Theft; Faulty Meter Replacement; Prepaid Metering; Bill Collection Facility; Reduce Debits; Energy Audit Schemes; Distribution System Mapping 05 Relation between Tariff and Energy Conservation: Terms involved in Tariff such as Units Consumed, Connected Load, Fixed Charges, Electricity Tax, Electricity Duty, Tariff Structure, Fuel Surcharge, Objectives of Tariff System, Tariff Structure or Types of Tariff- Flat Demand and Simple Tariff; Flat , Step, Block , Two Part and Three Part Tariff Rate, Specific Tariffs - Time of Day; Peak Off day; Maximum Demand Tariff; Load Factor Tariff Table , Power Factor Tariff - kVA Maximum Demand Tariff; kWh and kVARh Tariff; Sliding Scale Tariff , Application of Tariff System to Reduce Energy Bill- By Time of Usage (ToU) Tariff; By Power Factor Tariff ; By Load Factor Tariff [Simple Numerical Based on Power Factor and Load Factor Tariff ] 06 Energy Conservation by Cogeneration: Need for Cogeneration, Classification of the Cogeneration System- i)On the Basis of Sequence of Energy use ii)Topping Cycle iii)Bottoming Cycle, Classification of the Cogeneration System on the Basis of Technology- Steam Turbine Cogeneration System (Back Pressure and Extraction Condensing); Gas Turbine Cogeneration System (Open Cycle and Closed Cycle); Reciprocating Engine Cogeneration System(Spark Ignition and Compression Ignition), Factors Governing the Selection of Cogeneration System, Advantages of Cogeneration 07 Energy Conservation Equipment: About Energy Conservation Equipment, Energy Conservation Equipment’s Related to Lighting System- Credit Centralized Control Equipment; Occupancy Sensors / Motion Detectors(PIR, Ultrasonic and Microphonics / Microsonic Sensors); Control 02 Gears (Dimmers, Regulators and Stabilizers), Energy Conservation Equipment’s Related to Electric Motor- i) Soft Starters, Advantages of 'Soft Starter' Compared to ‘DOL Starter' and Voltage Control ii) Power Factor Controller- Bulk Correction / Centralized Compensation (APFC) and Static Capacitor iii) Automatic Star-Delta Starter-Principles of "ADLS" Operation and its limitations iv) Principles of operation of Autotransformer Starter v)Variable Frequency Drives (VFDs)- Working, Applications and Benefits of VFDs, Energy Conservation Equipment’s in Transmission and Distribution System-Maximum Demand Controller; Automatic Power Factor Controller- Voltage Control and kVAr Controller 08 Energy Audit: Energy Flow Diagrams and its Significance , Energy Audit Instruments and their use, Prepare Questionnaire for Energy Audit Projects, ABC Analysis, Energy Audit Procedure- Walk through Audit; Detailed Audit; Audit Procedure, Payback Period and its Payback Period Calculation DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity 01 To Collect the Information about Energy Conservation Act from IEE 2003 and Prepare a Report on it. 02 To Collect of Information and Prepare a Report on role of Energy Manager and Energy Auditor 03 To Collect of information and Prepare report on Rating, Luminous Output, Cost, List of Manufacturers of Various types of Energy Efficient Luminaries (FTL, CFL, LED, Sodium Vapour, HPMV etc.) 04 To Prepare report on Techno-economic performance comparison of Compact Fluorescent Lamps (CFL) with Light Emitting Diodes (LED), Electrode Less Fluorescent Lamps (EEFL), Fluorescent Tubes, Incandescent Bulbs 05 To Collect the Standard tariff rates and suggest suitable tariff for given industry/ Lab/ Institute/ Commercial establishment 06 To Perform Comparative study of Energy Efficient Control Gears and Ballasts used in Lighting System on the basis of Energy Efficiency, Energy Saving, Life, and Saving in Energy Bill 07 To Prepare a report by visiting to any one of organizations such as Hospitals, Workshops, Institutes, Commercial Building, Residential Building etc. where Energy Conservation Program is implemented 08 To perform energy audit using various energy audit instruments available for measurement of electrical, mechanical and thermal energy parameters, and prepare a report as a case study for Residential complex or own house. Suggest Energy Efficient Lighting Systems for flat or home. Credit Block Credit 01 Credit 02 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Page 94 09 To perform energy audit using various energy audit instruments available for measurement of electrical, mechanical and thermal energy parameters, and prepare a report as a case study for Small Workshop or Small Scale Industry. Suggest Energy Efficient Lighting Systems for Small Scale Industry. 10 To perform energy audit using various energy audit instruments available for measurement of electrical, mechanical and thermal energy parameters, and prepare a report as a case study for Public Hospital or Doctor’s Clinic. Suggest Energy Efficient Lighting Systems for Hospital. LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14055-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14055-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Energy Management Handbook, 8th ed 1466578289 , 978-1466578289 T14055-RB1 Wayne C. Turner, 2012 Fairmont Press T14055-RB2 Handbook on Energy Audit and Environment Management, Y P Abbi T14055-RB3 Electric Energy: Generation, Utilization and Conservation, S. Sivanagaraju, M. Balasubba Reddy, D. Srilatha T14055-RB4 Art & Science of Utilization of Electrical Energy, H. Partab, 2006 8131798771, 9788131798775 Pearson Education India 2013 Energy Efficient Motors, 2001 Dr. B E Kushare 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14055-CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! 1) http://www.beeindia.in/energy_managers_auditors/ema.php?id=4 2) Comparative study of energy saving light sources (PDF Download T14055-WL1 Available). Available from: http://www.researchgate.net/publication/264497456_Comparative_st udy_of_energy_saving_light_sources T14055-RB4 9788179930922 Teri Press EBK0009854 Dhanpat Rai & Sons , New Delhi, BY BEE Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 95 T14056: MICROCONTROLLER AND POWER ELECTRONICS PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 02. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14056 Course Name Microcontroller and Power Electronics Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 120 120 100 P Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘2 online SCORM lectures’ at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘2 face-to-face lectures (each of 45 minutes duration) at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each Term-Work or Practical session shall be of 240 minutes duration. Remaining time of 195 minutes after initial lectures of 45 minutes shall be used for actual conduct and reporting of Term-work/practical activities during each session. Evaluation Pattern: In total evaluation, Internal Examiner (IE) and External Examiner (EE) shall have 50% weightage. Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA) (Only by IE): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by EE): 20 Marks b. Actual Conduct of Practical by the student: 20 Marks (by EE) + 20 Marks (by IE) c. Viva on Practical Report/Activity: 10 Marks (by EE) + 10 Marks (by IE) PART I: MICROCONTROLLER PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand Hardware of Microcontroller Interface with Peripheral Devices Develop Programmes using Instruction Set Understand Steps involved in Execution of Microcontroller Programmes DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY Credit Block UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Course Content Covered in T14052: Microcontroller Credit 01 02 Course Content Covered in T14052: Microcontroller Credit 02 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity [Perform Any 10 Activities) Credit Block [Perform Any 5 Activities] 01 Introduction of Microcontroller Kit 02 Write a Program for Addition of two 8 bit numbers in Microcontroller 03 Write a Program for Subtraction of two 8 bit numbers in Microcontroller 04 Write a Program for Multiplication of two 8 bit numbers in Microcontroller 05 Write a Program for Division of two 8 bit numbers in Microcontroller 06 Write a Program to find the Maximum Value in the given Array 07 Write a Program to arrange the given data in Ascending Order Credit 01 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Page 96 08 Write a Program to find the Square Root of the given Data [Perform Any 5 Activities] 09 Develop a Program to Interface LED with Microcontroller and make LED ON and OFF with a Key Press 10 Develop a Programme to Interface 7-Segment Display with Microcontroller and Design Up/Down Counter on it 11 12 Develop a Programme to Interface Stepper Motor Develop a Programme to Interface ADC 13 Develop a Programme to Interface DAC 14 Write a Programme using Timer0 to Create a 10khz Square Wave on I/O Port 15 Develop a Programme to Interface DC motor control Develop a Programme to Interface Matrix Keyboard 16 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 02 LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Edition Year Title Author ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14056-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! th PIC Microcontroller and Embedded Systems using Assembly and c for 15 9788131716755, 9788131716755 T14052-TB1 PIC18, Impression Pearson Education Muhammad Ali Mazidi, Rolind D Mckinlay, Danny Causey 2014 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14052 -RB1 PIC Microcontrollers - Programming in C, Milan Verle 978-86-84417-17-8 mikroElektronika; 1st edition (2009) T14052–RB2 T14052–RB3 T14052 –RB4 T14052–RB5 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14056 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14056-WL1 PART II: POWER ELECTRONICS PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Observe, Draw and Interpretation Characteristics and the Output Waveforms of Power Devices Select, Connect and Handle carefully various Power Electronics Devices DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Course Content Covered in T14053: Power Electronics 02 Course Content Covered in T14053: Power Electronics Credit Block Credit 01 Credit 02 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 97 Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity [Perform Any 10 Activities) Credit Block [Perform any 5 Activities] 01 To Study and Plot the V-I characteristic of SCR 02 To Study and Plot V-I characteristics of DIAC 03 To Study and Plot V-I characteristics of TRIAC 04 To Study and Plot V-I characteristics of IGBT 05 Experimentally find out Latching and Holding Current of SCR 06 To Study the Effect of variation of R, C in R and RC Triggering Circuits on Firing Angle of SCR. 07 To Study and Draw the Output Waveforms Half-Wave Controlled Rectifier with R & RL load Credit 01 [Perform any 5 Activities] 08 To study and Draw the Output Waveforms Full-Wave Controlled Rectifier (mid-point configuration) with R & RL load 09 To Draw the Output Waveform of Full Wave Controlled Rectifier with Freewheeling Diode and Determine Load Voltage( for R /RL load) 10 To Study and Draw the Output Waveforms of Three Phase Half Wave Rectifier using Diodes 11 Demonstration on any one of the Turn OFF Methods of SCR 12 13 Demonstration on a Three Phase Half Wave Controlled Rectifier Demonstration on a Single Phase Inverter 14 Demonstration on a Light Dimmer Circuit Using Diac and Triac Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 02 LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14056-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14056-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Power Electronics, 2nd Ed, 9780070583894 T14053 –RB1 M D Singh and K B Khanchandani 2006 McGraw-Hill Power Electronics: Principle & Applications, 1st Ed, 9780070702394 T14053 –RB2 Vithayathil 2010 Tata McGraw-Hill Power Electronics: Circuits, Devices and Applications, 4th Ed, 0133125904, 978-0133125900, T14053 –RB3 Muhammad H. Rashid 2013 Prentice Hall of India st 9788125918530, Fundamentals of Power Electronics, 1 Ed, T14053 –RB4 2005 Vikas Publishing House S. K. Bhattacharya Industrial and Power Electronics, 10th Ed, 8188114146 , 9788188114146 T14053 –RB5 Harish C. Rai reprint Umesh Publications 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14056 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14056-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 98 SEMESTER 06 T14061: INDUSTRIAL MANAGEMENT PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V62: Diploma in Mechanical Engineering 02. V63: Diploma in Electronics and Telecommunication Engineering 03. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14061 Course Name Industrial Management Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Explain the principles and function of management Describe importance of management process and Forms of ownership in Business Explain need and importance of Safety in Industries, Legislative Acts, HRM, Financial Management, Material Management and Quality Improvement Techniques Understand Responsibilities & Expectations from Diploma holder in Business Environment DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 02 Credit Block Overview of Business: Introduction to Types of Business related to Service, Manufacturing and Trade, Introduction to Industrial Sectors like Engineering Industry; Process Industry; Textile Industry; Chemical Industry; Agro Industry; IT Industry; Banking Sector; Insurance Sector; Retailing Sector; Hospitality Sector/Industry; Health Care Industry, Introduction to Globalization, Impact of Impact of Liberalisation, Privatisation, Globalization (LPG) Policy, Advantages and Disadvantages of Globalization Credit Management Process: Evolution and Definitions of Management, Concept and Levels of Management, Administration, Management and 01 Organization, Scientific Management by F.W. Taylor, Principle of Management (14 Principles of Henry Fayol), Various Functions of Management like Planning, Organizing, Authority and Responsibility, Coordinating, Directing, Leadership, Controlling and Decision Making 03 Organizational Management: Definition and Principle of Organization, Steps in Forming Organization, Organization Structure, Types of Organization- Line Organization; Line and Staff Organization; Functional Organization; Project Organization, Departmentation -Centralized and Decentralization; Authority and Responsibility; Span of Control; Delegation; Balance, Stability and Flexibility; Communication, Forms and Ownerships- Proprietorship; Partnership; Joint Stock Company; Co-operative Society; Government Sector (Public Sector), Private Limited, Public Limited Companies and Public Undertaking Companies 04 Industrial Safety and Legislative Awareness: Safety Management related to Causes of Accidents, Types of Industrial Accidents, Preventive Credit 02 Measures and Safety Procedures, Industrial Legislation and its Necessity- Indian Factory Act; Workman Compensation Act; Minimum Wages Act, Definitions and Provisions of the Act, Authorities under the Act and their Powers, Pollution Control Act and environmental Preservation Act, Introduction to Commercial Terms - Quotation, Enquiries, PO; Payment Terms, Pricing, Delivery Terms, Insurance Aspects, Warranty, Bank Guarantee, Third party inspection, Earnest Money Deposit(EMD); Demurrages; Exports related Terminology or documents used for export/import transaction - Bill of Exchange(BOE), Air Way Bill(AWB), Penalty/LD Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 99 05 Supervisory Skills: Daily Resources Planning, Work Allocation, Skill Matrix Mapping, Result and Performance Evaluation, Data Gathering Credit of KPI (Key Performance Indicators), Liaison with Other Departments, Productivity, Housekeeping, Shop-floor Inventory, Shop-floor 03 Rejection / Wastage/ Scrap, Customer Inspection; Training Needs of Persons etc 06 Financial Management: Objectives and Functions of Financial Management, Capital Generation and Management-Types and Sources of Capitals, Production Budget and Labour Budget, Concept of Profit and Loss Account, Concept of Balance Sheet, Financial Terms involved with Definitions, Introduction to Various Taxes with their meaning and examples - Excise Duty; Service Tax; Income Tax; VAT; Custom Duty 07 08 Materials Management: Meaning and Objectives of Inventory Management, ABC Analysis Concept and its Graphical Representation, Introduction and Graphical Representation and Determination of Economic Order Quantity, Purchase Procedure- Objectives of Purchasing; Functions or Duties of Purchasing Department; Standard Steps in Purchasing; Material Requisition Format; Purchase Order Format, Modern Techniques of Material Management- Material Requirement Planning (MRP); Functions of MRP; Inputs to MRP; Benefits of MRP, Enterprise Resource Planning Credit Quality Management: Definition of Quality, Concept of Quality, Activities and Benefits Quality Management System, Functions of 04 Quality Control, Objectives and Advantages of Quality Control, Characteristics of Quality Circle, Quality Assurance, Meaning of Total Quality and TQM- Principles; Concept of Components of TQM; Elements and Benefits of TQM, Modern Technique and Systems of Quality Management- Introduction to i)Kaizen, ii) 5 'S', iii) Six Sigma, iv) Restriction of Hazardous Substance (ROHS)- compliance to this directive is required for exporting to EU, v) CE Marking (Conformite Europeenne)- an European Proof of Confirmity, vi)Value Engineering, ISO 9001:2000- Main Clauses of ISO 9001:2000 Standards and its Benefits LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14061-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14061-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Industrial Engineering and Management, 17th, 818992835X, 9788189928353 T14061 –RB1 O. P. Khanna 2010 Dhanpat Rai Publications Industrial Organisation & Engineering Economics, 24th 9788174090789, 8174090789 T14061 –RB2 T.R. Banga and S.C. Sharma Khanna Publishers Essentials of Management, 4th 9780132863377, 0132863375 T14061 –RB3 Joseph L. Massie Prentice Hall Industrial Engineering and Management, 8186308369, 978-8186308363 T14061 –RB4 2005 Dr. S. Dalela and Dr. Mansoor Ali Standard Publishers Distributors 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14061 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14061-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 100 T14062: SWITCHGEAR & PROTECTION PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14062 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Switchgear & Protection Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Explain Need and Function of Various Components of Switchgear and Protection System Describe Operation and Use of Various Types of Circuit Interrupting Devices and Protective Relaying Select an Appropriate Switchgear and Protection Scheme for a Particular Application UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 Fundamental of Protective System Circuit Interrupting Devices Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 03 04 Protection of Alternator Protection of Transformer Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 05 06 Protection of Motor Protective Relaying Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 07 08 09 Protection of Bus Bar and Transmission Line Neutral Earthing Over Voltage Protection Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer '1 of 1' SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Credit Block Fundamental of Protective System: Functions of Protective System, Power System Faults-Normal and Abnormal Conditions; Reasons of Credit Fault Occurrence; Types of Faults, Effects of Faults on Power System, Faults Statistics, Essential Qualities of Protection, Steps to Calculate 01 Systematical Short Circuit Current and Short Circuit k VA, Current Limiting Reactors with Classification Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 101 02 Circuit Interrupting Devices: Introduction to Circuit Interrupting Devices- Fuses; Semi Enclosed or Rewirable Fuse; High Rupturing Capacity (H.R.C.) Fuses, Characteristics of Fuse Element, Fuse Characteristics, Definitions of terms - Rated Current; Minimum Fusing Current; Fusing Factor; Prospective Current; Cut-off Current; Pre-arcing Time or Melting Time; Arcing Time; Total Operating Time and Rupturing Capacity (Breaking Capacity), Isolators and its Types of Construction, Earthing Switch, Fault Statistics- Oscillogram of Current and Voltage during the Fault Clearing; Arc Formation Process, Methods of Arc Extinction- Higher Resistance Method (Blow out Coil) and Low Resistance or Zero Point Extinction, Definition of Arc Voltage, Restriking Voltage and Recovery Voltage, Circuit BreakersClassification, Working principle, Construction, Specification and Applications of i) Air Break Circuit Breaker ii) Miniature Circuit Breaker (MCB) iii) Moulded Case Circuit Breaker (MCCB) iv) Earth Leakage Circuit Breaker (ELCB) v) Air Blast Circuit Breaker, Sulphur Hexafluoride (SF6) Circuit Breaker- Properties of SF6 Gas; Single Pressure Puffer Type SF6 Circuit Breaker; Merits and Demerits of SF6 Circuit Breaker; Typical Rating of SF6 Insulated Switchgear, Oil Circuit Breakers- Plain Break Oil and Low Oil Circuit Breakers (MOCB), Vacuum Circuit Breakers (VCB), Selection of Circuit Breaker, Rating of Circuit Breakers- Breaking Capacity; Making Capacity; Short Time Rating; Normal Current Rating, Problem of Circuit Interruption -Rate of Rise of Restriking Voltage; Current Chopping; Resistance Switching 03 Protection of Alternator: Abnormalities and Faults in Alternator, Percentage Differential Protection of Alternator, Restricted Earth Fault Protection, Over Current and Earth Fault Protection for Generator Backup, Sensitive Earth Fault Protection, 100% Stator Earth Fault Protection, Inter Turn Fault Protection- When the Stator Winding has Only One Paths and two Parallel Paths, Negative Sequence Protection of Generators against Unbalanced Load, Over Heating Protection, Reverse Power Protection 04 Protection of Transformer: Selection of Protection Scheme for a Power Transformer, Abnormalities and Remedies of Power Transformer, Buchholz relay, Earth-fault or Leakage Protection or Core Balance Protection, Biased Differential Protection, Percentage Differential Protection of Power Transformer – Limitations in Differential Protection; CT Connection; CT Ratios; Percentage Differential Protection Scheme, Earth Fault Protection- Residually Connected Earth Fault Relay and Earth Fault Relay Connected in Neutral to Earth Circuit, Restricted Earth Fault Protection, Over Current Protection of Power Transformer, Thermal Over-Heating Protection, Pressure Release Valve (PRV) 05 Credit 02 Protection of Motor: Abnormalities and Faults in Three Phase Induction Motor, Requirements of Motor Protection, Protection of Three Phase Induction Motor against i) Low Voltage (up to 1000 V) ii) Short Circuit iii) Overload Protection, Single Phasing Preventer 06 Protective Relaying: Functions of Protective Relaying, Basic Connection of Trip Circuit , Method of Primary and Back up Protection, Quality Requirements of Protective Relaying, Relay Timings, Definition of Important Terms- Pickup; Reset; Drop off/Pick up ratio; Instantaneous Relays; Inverse Time Relay; Definite Time Lag Relay; Current setting; Plug Setting Multiplier; Time setting Multiplier, Types of RelayElectromagnetic Relays; Induction Relays; Static Relays , Microprocessor Based Relay- Advantages and Special Features of Microprocessor Credit 03 Based Protective Relay, Current Transformers- Burden on CT; Magnetization Curve of CT; Accuracy Class, Voltage or Potential Transformer Burdens on Voltage Transformer; Types of Construction of VT’s; Errors in Instrument Transformer, Over Current Protection - Applications and Relays used in Over-Current Protection; Induction Type Over-Current Relay; Static Over-Current Relays; Microprocessor Based Over Current Relays, Distance Relaying- Principle and Operation of i)Definite Distance Relaying ii)Time Distance Relay iii) MHO Relay, Construction and Operation of Directional Relay (Reverse Power Relay), Operation of Differential Relays- Current Differential Relay and Voltage Balance Differential Relay, Introduction of Numerical Relays 07 Protection of Bus bar and Transmission Line: Abnormalities and Faults of Transmission lines, Bus Bar Protection -Differential Protection Credit and Fault Bus Protection, Protection of Transmission Line- Requirements; Methods of Transmission Line Protection- i) Time Graded over 04 current Protection ii)Differential Protection iii) Distance Protection iv) Phase Comparison Protection 08 Neutral Earthing: Concept of Neutral Grounding or Neutral Earthing, Disadvantages of Ungrounded Systems, Advantages of Neutral Grounding, Type of Grounding or Earthing- Ungrounded System; Solid or Effective Earthing; Resistance Earthing; Reactance Earthing; Resonant Earthing, Earthing Transformer, Substation Earthing System with different parts and Functions, Step and Touch Potential, Equipotential Grounding 09 Over Voltage Protection: Concept of Voltage Surge , Causes of Over Voltages such as Internal Causes, Lightening, Protection against Lightening- Earthing Screen; Overhead Ground Wires; Lighting Arresters, Types of Lighting Arresters with construction and Principle of Operation such as Rod Gap, Horn Gap, Expulsion Type and Valve Type Arrester, Surge Absorber- Definition and working with neat diagram, Insulation Co-ordination- Need; Volt Time Curve; Basic Impulse Insulation Level (BIL) LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14062-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14062-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Switchgear Protection And Power Systems, 13th 9788174092328, T14062 –RB1 Sunil S Rao 2014 Khanna Publishers Power System Protection and Switchgear, 1st Reprint 007107774X, 9780071077743 T14062 –RB2 Badri Ram 2011 Tata McGraw-Hill Education Text Book on Power System Engineering, 8177000209, 978-8177000207 T14062–RB3 2008 A. Chakrabarti , P. V. Gupta , Soni Ml Dhanpat Rai Publishing Company (P) Ltd. Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 102 Electrical Power Systems, Reprint Wadhwa, C L Apr, 2014 Switchgear and Power System Protection, T14062 –RB5 2009 Ravindra P. Singh 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14062 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14062-WL1 T14062 –RB4 978-81-224-2839-1 New Age Publications 8120336607, 9788120336605 PHI Learning Pvt. Ltd Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 103 T14063: ELECTRICAL TESTING AND MAINTENANCE PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14063 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Electrical Testing and Maintenance Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand the Concept of Preventive and Routine Maintenance, Concept of Safety, Principle of Stable Operation of Electrical Machines Use detailed guidelines as per I.S. Codes and I.E. Rules for Testing, Maintenance, Erection and Installation of Electrical Equipment’s (Latest) UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Safety Measures and Prevention of Accidents Testing of Electrical Machines-1 Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 03 Testing of Electrical Machines-2 Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 04 05 Maintenance of Electrical Machines Testing and Reconditioning of Insulating Materials Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 06 07 Fault Finding & Trouble Shooting of Electrical Machines Installation and Earthing of Electrical Machines Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 02 DETAIL SYLLABUS Credit Block UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Safety Measures and Prevention of Accidents: Concept of Electric Safety, Electric Accidents, its Causes and Preventions- Definitions of Terminology used in Safety; Electric Accident (Meaning and Reasons) and how can be Avoided; Precaution to be taken by every House Holder using Electricity for Domestic Purpose and Appliances, Safety Signs and Symbols Used in Industries, I.E. Act and Statutory Regulation for Safety of Persons and Equipments working with Electrical Installation, Electric Shock – Reasons; Factors Affecting the Severity of Shock and Body Resistance (R); Action to be taken when person gets an Electrical Shock; Cure of Electric Shock (Rescuing Electrocute Person); Different Methods of Artificial Respiration; Precaution to be taken while Working on Electrical Installation; Concept of Permit System; Causes of Fire due to Electrical Faults and Precautions to be taken-Attack on the Fire; Types of different Fire Extinguishers; Advantages of CO2 Extinguisher over other types; Operation of Fire Extinguisher Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 104 02 Testing of Electrical Machines-1: Importance of Testing, Roles of Bureau of Indian Standards in Testing of Electrical Equipment (Objectives of ISS), Tests on Electrical Machines Before Commissioning, Methods of Testing - Brake Test (Direct test on DC Machine); Calibrated Machine Test (Direct test on DC Machine); Swinburne’s Test (No Load in Direct Method); Back to Back Test (Regenerative/ Hopkinson’s Test), Concept of Tolerance, Testing of Transformer (IS 2026)- Testing of Transformer as per IS 2026; Routine Tests- Measurement of D.C. Resistance of Winding; Measurement of Voltage Ratio and Check of Voltage Vector Relationship (Polarity Test and Phasing-out Test); Credit Measurement of No load and Magnetizing Current; Measurement of Impedance and Load Loss (Cu Loss); Measurement of Insulation 01 Resistance; Dielectric Tests: (Special Test); Test on No Load Tap-changers, Type Tests -Temperature Rise Test; Back to Back (Sumpner’s Test) (for two Identical 1-phase Transformers) (Regenerative test); Back to Back Test (Sumpner’s Test) on 3-phase Transformer Test; Back to Back (Sumpner’s Test) Test on Two Y-Y Connected Transformers 03 Testing of Electrical Machines-2: Testing of 3-phase Induction Motors using Routine Tests and Type Tests, Routine Tests in DetailsInsulation Resistance Test; Measurement of D.C. Resistance of a 3-phase Induction Motor; High Voltage Test; No Load Running of Motor and Reading of Current in the Three phases and Voltage; Open Circuit Voltage Ratio Test; Locked Rotor readings of Voltage, Current and Power Input at Suitable Reduced Voltage; Reduced Voltage Running Up Test; Measurement of Slip, Type Tests in Details-Temperature Rise Test; Momentary Overload Test; Effect of Variation of Voltage and Frequency on the Performance of Electric Machines; Behaviour of 3 phase Induction Motor Under Abnormal Frequency, Vector Diagram and Equivalent Circuit of a 3 Phase Induction Motor- Vector Diagram; Equivalent Circuit of Induction Motor; Examples on Equivalent Circuit, Circle Diagram of a 3 phase Induction Motor- Test to Draw Circle Diagram; How to Draw the Circle Diagram ?; How to get maximum Quantities from the Circle Diagram?, Testing of Single Phase Induction Motors- Types i) Resistance Split Phase Motor ii) Capacitor Split Phase Motors iii) Shaded Pole Type Motor, Use of Thermal Relay (Thermostat) for Protecting the Motor, Use of Reversing Switch for Changing the Direction of Rotation, Testing of Single Phase Induction Motor- Insulation Resistance Test; High Voltage Test; No Load Test; Block Motor Test; Quiet Running Test, Type Tests- Temperature Rise Test; Momentary Overload Test; Load Test; Moisture Ingrace Test; Leakage Current Test; Pull out torque test, Testing of Synchronous Machines- Explanation of Open Circuit and short Circuit Test/ Emf Method/ Synchronous Impedance Methods of Finding Voltage Credit Regulation, Loss Measurement of Synchronous Machine; Temperature Rise Test; Over speed Test on Synchronous Motor, H.V. Testing, 02 Insulation Resistance Test, Waveform Deviation and Distortion Factors, DC and AC Resistance of Armature and Field Winding Measurements, Dielectric Test on Armature (Stator) and Field (Rotor) Windings, Phase Sequence, Synchronising Circuit Testing (Need and Condition for Satisfactory Parallel Operation), Procedure of Synchronising, Dark Lamp Method of Synchronising, Drawback of Dark Lamp Method, One Dark Two Equally Bright Lamp Method of Synchronising, Synchroscope, Testing of Voltage Regulators and Excitation Circuit Testing, Voltage Recovery Test, Retardation Test, Parallel Operation of 3 Phase Transformers- Need and Condition for Satisfactory Parallel Operation of Single Phase Transformers, Factors affecting the Parallel Operation, Procedure of Checking the Polarity of 3 Phase Transformers before Parallel Operation, Connection of T1 and T2 in Parallel for Y and Y Vector Group 3, Thing are to be Checked Prior to Paralleling, Open Delta or V-V Connection - Concept of Open Delta or V-V Connection, Situation in which V-V Connection is Used, Advantages and Disadvantages of V-V Connections, Parallel Operation of Alternators- Synchronising Action, Effect of Change in Speed, Effect of Inequality of EMF/ Unequal Voltage, Effect of Change in Excitation, Effect of Change in Input to Prime-movers (Change in Steam Supply and Change in Mechanical Torque), Control of Active Reactive Power and Power Factor, Effect of Failure of Field and Prime Mover, Synchronising Power [Numerical based on content covered] 04 Maintenance of Electrical Machines: Importance of Preventive Maintenance for Motors, Generators and Transformers, Concept of Routine Maintenance, Preventive Maintenance and Breakdown Maintenance, Comparison between Preventive Maintenance and Breakdown Maintenance, Routine and Breakdown Maintenance of Electrical Equipment, Frequency of Inspection, Procedure of Developing Preventive Maintenance Schedule, Factors Affecting Preventive Maintenance Schedule, Concept of ‘Total Productive Maintenance’, Causes of Failure of Electric Machines (Internal and External Causes), Identification of Different Types of Faults Developed Credit such as Mechanical Faults, Electrical Faults and Magnetic Faults, Factors of Affecting Life of Transformer- Maintenance Schedule for 03 Transformer of Capacities i) less than 1000 KVA ii)more than 1000 KVA and iii) Routine Preventive Maintenance of Transformers, Preventive Maintenance of Induction Motor-Objectives of Maintenance; Effect of absence of Maintenance; Maintenance Schedule (Planned Schedule), Preventive maintenance of induction Motor and its Activities, Maintenance Schedule for Synchronous Machines, Batteries (Lead Acid and Alkaline) and their Maintenance 05 Testing and Reconditioning of Insulating Materials: Properties of Insulating Materials, Classification of Insulating Materials as per IS 1271, Factors Affecting Life of Insulating Material, Measurement of Insulation Resistance- By Using Megger; Insulation Resistance Measurement by Voltmeter Method; Dielectric Absorption Test by using Megger; Polarization Index; Measurement of Insulation Resistance, Reconditioning of Insulated Materials - Methods of Cleaning Insulation; Drying of Insulation; Revarnishing of Insulation; Vacuum Impregnation, Insulating Oil- Properties of Good Transformer Oil; Causes of Degradation of Oil; Transformer Oil and its Impurities; Testing of Transformer Oil as per IS 1866, Breakdown Test of Transformer Oil as per IS, Methods of Purification and Filteration of Insulating Oil Centrifugal Purifier; Stream Line Filter (Vacuum Type); Filter using Activated Earth Media; Prevention of Electrical Machine (Equipment)during the Period of Inactivity 06 Fault Finding & Trouble Shooting of Electrical Machines: Trouble Shooting of Electrical Equipments-Limits of Voltage, Current, Frequency and Speed for Safe Working of Electrical Machines , Internal and External Causes for failure and Abnormal Operation of Equipments, List of Mechanical Faults, Electrical Faults and Magnetic Faults in Electrical Equipments , Various Tools used for Repairs and Maintenance Bearing puller; Filler Gauges; Dial Test Indicator; Spirit level; Megger; Earth Tester; Growler, Other Tools used for checking/ Measurements- Credit Gauge of Conductor Wire; Instrument Transformers and Multimeter, Common Troubles or faults in Electrical Equipments and Machines04 Troubles and Causes in Transformer; Failures Due to Structural Defects; Troubles, Faults, Reasons in Induction Motor; 3-Phase Induction Motor types of Faults, Reasons and Remedial Measures; Troubles/Faults in Cables, Trouble Shooting Chart - for DC Machines, AC Machines, Induction Motor, Transformer, Abnormal Conditions of Transformer, Faults, Remedies and Trouble Shooting for Transformers Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 105 07 Installation and Earthing of Electrical Machines: Common Trouble in Electrical Installation, Factors Involved in Designing Machine Foundation, Requirements of Foundation of Static and Rotating Electric Machinery - Producer of Levelling and Alignment and Producer for Alignment of Direct-Coupled Drive and Indirect Couple Drive, Effects of Misalignment , Installation of Floor Mounted Transformer - For Civil works; Steps to be follow before coming on Transformer, Installation of Pole Mounted Transformer-Material and Accessories Required for Pole Mounted Sub-Station; Installation Procedure of Pole Mounted Sub-Station; Checklist for ‘Before Commissioning’; Commissioning of Transformer, Installation of Rotating Electrical Machines, Devices and Tools Required for Loading - Precautions to be taken while Handling these Devices, Importance and Purpose of Earthing, Types of Earthing- Plate and Pipe, Indian Electricity Rules For Earthing, What will Happen if the Neutral is not Grounded?, Objectives of Grounding, Methods of Neutral Grounding- Solid Grounding; Resistance Grounding; Reactance Grounding; Arc Suppression Coil Grounding (Peterson Coil Grounding); Voltage Transformer Earthing, Symbolic Representation of Neutral Earthing for Different Equipment LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14063-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14063-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Design and Testing of Electrical Machines 9788120336452 T14063 –RB1 2013 Deshpande, M. V PHI Learning Private Limited, Operation & Maintenance of Electrical Machines Vol – I, latest reprint Media Promoters & Publisher Ltd. Mumbai T14063 –RB2 B. V. S. Rao T14063 –RB3 Operation & Maintenance of Electrical Machines Vol – II, B. V. S. Rao latest reprint 8185099022 Media Promoters & Publisher Ltd. Mumbai T14063 –RB4 A Textbook of Electrical Technology: Volume II: AC & DC Machines , B. L. Theraja 23rd Revised Edition 8121924375 / 9788121924375 S. Chand & Company Ltd, New Delhi, India Switchgear Protection and Power Systems, 2008 Sunil S Rao 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14063 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! http://www.cdc.gov/niosh/topics/SHAPE/pdfs/elecengineer.pdf T14063-WL1 www.lanl.gov/safety/electrical/docs/skilled_worker_module_6.ppt For standards refer http://www.bis.org.in/sf/pow/etd.pdf T14063 –RB5 8174092323, 978-8174092328 Khanna Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 106 ELECTIVE - I: ANYONE OF COURSE FROM T14064 OR T15064 T14064: ILLUMINATION ENGINEERING PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14064 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Illumination Engineering Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Understand concept of Illumination and Terminology used Describe Construction, working principle, Characteristics, Advantages, Disadvantages and Applications of Lamps and Luminaires Explain Illumination Control, Control Circuits and Design Select the appropriate Lamps for Electrification of Areas UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions 01 02 Fundamentals of Illumination Lamps and Lighting Accessories Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 03 04 Illumination Control and Control Circuits Lighting for Special Applications Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 05 Illumination for Interior Application Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 06 Illumination for Outdoor Applications Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Credit Block Fundamentals of Illumination: Fundamentals of Illumination, Definitions of Illumination Terminology, Laws of Illuminations- Law of Credit Inverse Squares; Lambert’s Cosine Law and cos 3 (theta) Law, Simple Numerical Examples based on Illuminations Laws, Features and 01 Advantages of Good Illumination Scheme, Mesopic Effect of LED Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 107 02 03 04 Lamps and Lighting Accessories: Types of Light based on Inter-relation of Frequency, Wave Length and Velocity and Spectrum of Radiant Energy, Wave Length and Colour Sensation Table, Types of Lamps - Construction, Working, Fault Finding, Advantages and Applications of i)Incandescent Lamps ii) Carbon Arc Lamps iii)Fluorescent Lamps and comparison between Filament/Incandescent Lamp and Gas Discharge Lamp, iv)Mercury Vapour Lamp v) Mercury Iodide Lamps vi) Sodium Vapour Lamp vii)Neon Lamp viii)Halogen Lamp ix) Compact Fluorescent Lamp (Tube) (CFL) x) Metal Halide Lamp xi) LED xii) Special Lamp, Comparison of all Luminaires (Lamps), Lighting Schemes – Types of Lamps based on Area of Illumination; Illumination Efficiency and Power Consumption of Various Types of Lamps; Effects of Shadows and Glare on the Smooth Working, Types of Lighting Schemes such as Direct Lighting; Semi-Direct Lighting; Indirect Lighting; Semi-Indirect Lighting and General Lighting, Lighting Calculation Methods Illumination Control and Control Circuits: Basic Principle of Light Control- Mirror or Specular Reflection and Diffuse Reflection, Illumination Levels/ Efficiency of Electrical Installation, Dimmers - Variable Resistance Type like Resistance Type and Salt Water Dimmer, Dimmer Transformer- Autotransformer and Two Winding Transformer; Electronic Dimmer- Thyristor Operated and Triac Operated, Methods of Light Control- One Lamp Controlled by one Switch; Two Lamp Controlled by two Switches; Control of two Lights and One Fan by their Individual Switches, Show Control on One Board; Control of One Lamp and One Plug Point (three pin socket) on One Board and One Bell from another Board, Each Point Controlled Separately by its Switch, Series Parallel Circuit - With Two-Way and Off Switch; With One SP Switch and One Two Way and Off Switch, One Lamp Controlled by Two Way Switches or Stair-Case Wiring; Corridor Lighting; Lamps in Series and Parallel; Godown Wiring; Master ON Control and Master OFF Circuit; Arrangement of Single-Phase supply; Wiring Credit Diagram Showing Connection of Supplier’s Main Board, Consumer’s Main Board With DP MCB and Single Pole MCB Showing Sub Circuits; 02 Lamp Controlled from 3 points and 4 Points Lighting for Special Applications: Agriculture and Horticulture Lighting Schemes for- Agriculture Farms; Cultivation; Farm-House; Green House; Park and Garden Lighting, Healthcare Centers and Hospitals Lighting Schemes for - Health Care Centre; Hospital and Operating Theatres; Illumination Levels and Limiting Glare Index in Different Places of Big Hospital; Methods of Lighting Provisions in General Wards and Special Wards; Nursing Service to Admitted Patients; Luminaries in Hospital, Decorative Lighting/ Recreation Lighting, Stage Lighting Lights Requirements and Lamps used on Stage Lighting; Scenes in Dramas and Required Light Effects, Lighting Schemes for Aquarium and Shipyards- Lighting Schemes for Aquarium; Shipyard Lighting- Requirement; Detailed Activities and Lighting Provisions; Light Houses, Luminaries used on Docks 05 Illumination for Interior Application: General Requirements for Designing the Illumination Schemes, Important Objectives of Interior Design, Selection of Lamps- Control; Maintenance of Lighting Scheme; Flow Diagram of Objectives, General Electric Supply Systems in Residential and Commercial and Industrial Units- Types of Sub-Circuits; Concept of Commercial Installations; Difference between Residential and Commercial Installations; Design Considerations of Electrical Installation System for Commercial Building; Load Calculations and Selection of size of Service Connection and Nature of Supply; Concept of Industrial Load, Residential Lighting (Illumination)- Light Sources for Room Lighting; Illumination Levels for Domestic Lighting; Residential Lighting Provision; Lighting Systems Credit in Home Lighting; Residential Illumination Design, Commercial Lighting- Office Lighting; Requirements of Lighting in Office for Different 03 Activities; General Rules for Interior Lighting; Office Buildings; Lighting Provision and Luminaires used, Lighting Schemes or Illumination Recommendations for School, College and Library, Lighting for Hotels - Illumination Recommendations for Hotels, General and Specific Requirement of these areas- Entrance Hall; Extension to Entrance Hall; Reception Suites; Dining Rooms; Corridors, Stairs and Lifts; Bed Rooms; Restaurants; Pubs and Clubs, Industrial Lighting - Illumination Recommend for Machine and Fitting Shops; Working Planes; Suitable Luminaries for Various Works in Industry; Objective of Industries Lighting; Benefits of Good Industrial Lighting; General Lighting Requirements; Uniqueness of Industrial Tasks; Planning Steps; Quality of Light; Component of Industrial Lighting 06 Illumination for Outdoor Applications: Objectives of Exterior or Outdoor Lighting, General Requirements and Specific Requirements of Outdoor Lighting Scheme, Small Industries/ Factory Lighting - Use of Natural Sun Light and Electrically Produced Light; Lighting for Open Space around the Factory, Street Lighting – Objectives; Descriptions of Road; Classes of Roads; Important Terms in Road Lighting; Isolux Diagram; Recommendation for Direct Visual Guidance; Residential Street Lighting as Per CIE 92; Lighting Classes for Different Road Types in Pedestrian Areas; Arrangement of Luminaires on Straight Road; Arrangement of Luminaires at Special Situations; Road Lighting Code in India (IS 1944 Part 1 and 2); Pedestrian Crossing Lighting; Lighting with Optical Fibre Operating Principle, Street Light Poles and Connections- Electric Light Sources; Street Lighting Scheme and its Design; Basic Requirements of Street Lighting; Locations of Lamps and Credit their Advantages, Flood Lighting - Meaning of Flood Lighting and its Applications, Types of Luminaires Required for Flood Lighting, Flood 04 Lighting Projector- Reflecting Surface; Classification of Projectors (Tree Pattern); Lamps Used for Different Projectors; Location/ Mounting of Projectors for Flood Lighting, Some Fitting, Holders, Fixtures of Flood Lighting Luminaires, Luminaires, Illumination Level for Flood Lighting, Calculations on Flood Lighting Scheme, Factors considered in Illumination Calculation, Railway Platform Lighting, Lighting for Advertisement /Holdings with Procedure of Display, Sport Lighting and its Types, Requirement of Illumination for Sports - Categories of Sports Fixed by International Authority; Television Coverage Sports; Luminance Variation Recommendation for External Sport Lighting; Lamp used for Indoor and Outdoor Sports Numericals on Street Lighting and Flood Lighting Learning Resource Details Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14064-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14064-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 108 Applied Illumination Engineering, Jack L. Lindsey FIES Lighting Engineering: Applied Calculations, R. H. Simons 3rd December 2000 0824748093, 978-0824748098 Fairmont Press 978-0-7506-5051-9 ARCHITECTURAL PRESS T14064 –RB3 Lamps and Lighting, M. A. Cayless, A. M. Marsden 4th 2011 9780415503082, Routledge T14064 –RB4 Illumination engineering: from Edison's lamp to the laser, Joseph B. Murdoch Illustrated print 1885750005, 9781885750006 Visions Communications T14064 –RB1 T14064 –RB2 Utilisation of Electric Power : Including Electric Drives and Electric 2nd Traction, T14064 –RB5 2014 Suryanarayana, N.V . 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14064-CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! http://www.nptel.ac.in/downloads/108105061/ http://freevideolectures.com/Course/2344/Illumination-Engineering# T14064-WL1 http://www.freeengineeringbooks.com/Electrical/IlluminationEngineering.php For standards refer http://www.bis.org.in/sf/pow/etd.pdf 978-81-224-3681-5 New Age International Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 109 T15064: MODERN ELECTRIC TRACTION PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T15064 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 45 120 100 TH Modern Electric Traction Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘3 online SCORM lectures’ followed by ‘1 face-to-face lecture at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘4 face-to-face lectures at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each lecture shall be of 45 minutes duration. Evaluation Pattern: Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Explain the Operation of Power Supply Arrangements, OHE, Current Collecting Equipments, Signaling and Train Lighting, Power and Auxiliary Circuits of Electric Locomotive. Apply ‘Protection and Maintenance of Electric Locomotive’ Procedure Describe the recent Trends in Electric Traction- LEM Propelled Traction, Mono and Metro Rail System, Work as Supervisor or Controller in the field, where Electric Traction is used UNITS UN Name of the Unit CSs Questions Power Supply Arrangements Credit 01 CSs TL: 01-12 CA: 13-15 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 02 Overhead Equipment and Current Collection Equipment Credit 02 CSs TL: 16-27 CA: 28-30 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 03 04 Electric Locomotives Protection and Maintenance of Electric Locomotive Credit 03 CSs TL: 31-42 CA: 43-45 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 05 06 Signaling and Train Lighting Modern Trends in Electric Traction Credit 04 CSs TL: 46-57 CA: 58-60 Students have to answer ‘1 of 1’ SAQ in CA and ‘4 of 4’ SAQ end exam on these units. 01 DETAIL SYLLABUS UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Credit Block Power Supply Arrangements: Introduction to Traction Supply System-DC System; Single and Three Phase AC System; Composite System, Components of Supply System- Substations; Feeding Post; Feeding and Sectioning Arrangement; Sectioning and Paralleling Post; Sub Sectioning and Paralleling Post; Sub Sectioning Post; Elementary Section, Miscellaneous Equipment at Control Post or Switching Stations, Credit Major Equipment at Substation-Transformer; Circuit Breaker; Interrupters; Major Equipment at Substations, Protective System for AC 01 Traction- Transformer Protection and 25 kV Catenary Protection, Factors Deciding Location and Spacing of Traction Substation Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 110 02 03 04 Overhead Equipment and Current Collection Equipment: Overhead Equipment (OHE) - Design Principles of OHE, Automatic Weight Tension and Temperature Compensation, Un-insulated and Insulated Overlaps, Neutral Section, Section Insulator and Isolator, Polygonal Credit OHE, Effect of Speed on OHE, OHE Supporting Structure, Different types of Signal Boards of OHE, Current Collection Equipment- System 02 of Supplying Power in Electric Traction, Current Collectors for Overhead System, Types of Pantograph, Methods of Raising and Lowering of Pantograph Electric Locomotives: Classification of Locomotives and Electric Multiple Unit (EMU), Power Circuit - Power Circuit Diagram of AC Locomotives; Equipments in Power Circuit and their Functions; Equipments in Auxiliary Circuit and their Functions, List and Function of Different type of Relays, List and Purpose of Different Type of Contactors, Three Phase Locomotive- Power Circuit of Three Phase Locomotive; Power Supply Arrangement for Auxiliary; Machines in Three Phase Locomotive Protection and Maintenance of Electric Locomotive: Protection of Electric Locomotive -Broad Strategy for Protection; Surge Protection; Credit 03 Overload Protection of Main Power Circuit; Earth Fault Protection of Power and Auxiliary Circuit; Protection from Over Voltage and Under Voltage; Differential Current Protection of Traction Circuits; Protection against High and Low Air Pressure in the Air Circuit; Temperature Monitoring, Maintenance of Locomotive - Need of Maintenance and Policy of Obsolescence; Defects; Ideal Maintenance; Means to Improve the Reliability of Locomotive; Means to Improve Availability of Locomotive; Means to Reduce Maintenance Cost; Maintenance Record; Characteristics of Efficient Maintenance; Electrical Faults and Their Causes 05 Signaling and Train Lighting: Signaling - Requirement of Signaling System; Types of Signals; Colour Light Signals; Three and Four Aspects of Colour Light Signals; Track Circuits; Audio Frequency Track Circuit and High Frequency Track Circuit; Difference between DC Track Circuit and AC Track Circuit, Supervisory Control - Advantages of Remote Control; Remote Control System; Mimic Diagram; Control Desk for TPC, Train Lighting- Train Lighting Systems; Special Requirements of Train Lighting; Method of obtaining Unidirectional Polarity; Method of obtaining Constant Output; Single Battery System; Double Battery Parallel Block System; Failure of under Frame Generating Equipments; End on Generation 06 Modern Trends in Electric Traction: Linear Electric Motor (LEM) Propelled Traction, Linear Induction Based Traction System- Moving Primary Fixed Secondary Single Sided LIM (Linear Induction Motor); Moving Secondary Fixed Primary Single Sided LIM; Moving Primary Fixed Secondary Double Sided LIM; Differentiate Moving Primary Fixed Secondary and Moving Secondary Primary Single Sided Linear Induction Motor (LIM); Differentiate between moving Secondary Fixed Primary Single Sided LIM and moving Primary Secondary Double sided LIM with a Neat Sketch, Strengths/ Weakness of LIM Propelled Railway Traction System, Practical Possibilities of LIM Propelled Transportation Credit 04 LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T15064-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T15064-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! th Modern Electric Traction, 4 Book Code : 006527 of Jain Book Depo T15064 –RB1 H Partab 2015 Dhanpat Rai and Sons Electric Traction 2009 8177640054, 9788177640052 T14064 –RB2 by J. Upadhyay, Mehendra Allied Publishers Pvt. Ltd. T15064 –RB3 Electric traction handbook : control Brooks, Robert T15064 –RB4 Utilisation of Electric Power: Including Electric Drives &Electric Traction, Suryanarayana, N.V T15064 –RB5 Electric Traction A.T. Dover Mac Millan, Sir Isaac Pitman and sons ltd. London 2nd 2014 978-81-224-3681-5 New Age International Dhanpat Rai and Sons, New Delhi S P Khade spkhade@hotmail.com 9769625875 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T15064-CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! http://www.irfca.org/faq/faq-elec.html http://www.irfca.org/faq/faq-elec2.html www.irieen.com (Indian Railways Institute of Electrical Engineering, T15064-WL1 Nasik Road) www.wr.railnet.gov.in/bctweb/ELECTRICAL.htm www.scrailway.gov.in www.rdso.indianrailways.gov.in Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 111 T14065: PROJECT -WORK PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 01 V55 T14065 Project-Work 4 120 120 100 PW Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘2 online SCORM lectures’ at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘2 face-to-face lectures (each of 45 minutes duration) at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each Term-Work or Practical session shall be of 240 minutes duration. Remaining time of 195 minutes after initial lectures of 45 minutes shall be used for actual conduct and reporting of Term-work/practical activities during each session. Evaluation Pattern: In total evaluation, Internal Examiner (IE) and External Examiner (EE) shall have 50% weightage. Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA) (Only by IE): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by EE): 20 Marks b. Viva on Term-Work Submission by the student: 30 Marks (by EE) + 30 Marks (by IE) PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Explore solutions for the real problems, encountered in a real life job, in the complete project execution from start to finish, by applying basic concepts, principles and skills Develop basic technical Skills by hands on experience Analyze the problem and Interpret Result Write project report DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY Credit Block UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 The Project Work must involve practical work related to Electrical Engineering The topics of project may be selected related to the Development of working models or Industrial Problem Solving or to develop required skills in consultation with teacher / guide/ industry expert or Development of Innovative idea with its practical feasibility For selection of project, study center may help by involving students in activities such as group Discussion, a seminar on technical topic, 03 workshops or inviting experts from various industries for sharing their experiences, arranging industrial visits, quality circles, seminars and mini projects etc 02 Credit 01 & 02 04 Students have to bear cost of expenditure on “Project Work”. 05 The original design requirements are not essential, although highly encouraged. Projects should not be repeated. Employed Students are allowed to complete “Project Work” in the industry where he is employed or his place of choice. Such a student has 06 to identify a resource person in industry, who can take responsibility of guiding him in project work. Such person should be eligible to work as “Project Guide”. Study center should assist unemployed students, in locating sponsored “Projects” from local industries. Students are encouraged to locate 07 sponsored projects from the local industries. But, in case, a student is unable to locate such project, he is also allowed to complete “Project Work” at his study center The university encourages large Joint projects, requiring the participation of a small team of students. However, in such cases, clear 08 delegation of work and responsibilities, among the students, must be clearly stated in the “Project Report”. Maximum number of students, in a team for joint project, should not exceed 5 Credit 03 & 04 Study center should assist unemployed students, in locating sponsored “Projects” from local industries. Students are encouraged to locate 09 sponsored projects from the local industries. But, in case, a student is unable to locate such project, he is also allowed to complete “Project Work” at his study center 10 Each “Project Guide” may be assigned maximum three projects. Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 112 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity 01 Selection of the Project and Project Guide 02 Preparation of Project Execution Plan : Time and Resource Allocation Guidance by the Project Guide, for the self-study of relevant course topics and concepts by the student Self-study of relevant course topics and concepts by the student. 03 04 07 Each student shall maintain individual Project Diary for noting progress and Project Diary shall be duly signed by project Guide during regular interaction Preparation of Draft report with Project Specifications by the student Guidance and approval by Project Guide for Project Specifications 08 Design, Development, Testing and Troubleshooting of Prototype 05 06 09 10 11 12 13 Comparison of Prototype Performance with Set Project Specifications and Preparation of list showing (1) Problems (2) Improvements Needed (3) External Enclosure Details. The Project Guide should guide the student about this task Design, Development, Testing and Troubleshooting of Final Prototype Preparation of Project Report and all technical documentation like Schematic Drawings, Connection or Wiring Diagrams, Mechanical Drawings, Complete Bill of Material, User Instructions, Artwork and Films, List of Problems encountered etc Suggested Scheme of Chapters in Project Report: 1. Chapter 1: Introduction: Background of the project, Need for the project, Brief idea of the project 2. Chapter 2: System Overview and Design: Present the overview of the complete system. Use Block Diagrams. Specify design parameters for the system. Specify interfacing problems (if any) visualized beforehand, and how to eliminate these. 3. Chapter 3: Module Design: Discuss individual parts (sub-part) in details, clearly indicating the scientific principles involved and design of each sub-circuit used in a project. 4. Chapter 4: Testing and Troubleshooting: Discuss how the sub-parts were tested, how the complete system was tested and how measurements were made. Include observations. 5. Chapter 5: Results and Conclusions: Analyze the observations made in previous chapter. Discuss why the specifications were not met or the reasons for the failure, if any. Discussed the problems and difficulties encountered and how they were / can be eliminated. Discuss any extension work or modifications, which you want to suggest. 6. Chapter 6: References: List the books, magazines and data manuals used Submission Process: Student should prepare 2 copies of the Project Report. At the beginning, the respective Project Guide must approve both copies positively before the end examination of Project Work. Then respective Study Center Coordinator approves both copies of the Project Report. Student should submit one of these approved copies to the study center. The student should retain remaining one of these approved copies. Study center should preserve their copy of, all project reports, till the end examination of Project Work. Even student must bring his own copy during this end examination Credit Block Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 01 Credit 02 Credit 03 Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 04 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 113 Project Report Format: 1. The project report should be printed on only right side of A4 size (210 mm ´ 297 mm) paper. There is no minimum or maximum page number limit for the “Project Report”, but report of minimum 30–50 page is expected. University recommends only flexible binding for the “Project Report”. But, if student wishes, he may also use spiral binding. 2. Margins should be as follows :· 14 Left Margin : 40 mm Right Margin : 20 mm Top Margin : 20 mm Bottom Margin : 27 mm 3. Header should not be used. Footer, containing page number at the center should only be used, with footer margin of 25 mm. 4. Text should be printed in font size of 12 points and at interline distance of 18 points. (That is 1.5 line spacing). Normally, figures should be embedded in the text, where their first reference occurs. But if necessary, figures may be grouped on separate pages. Figure should be numbered as ‘Fig C.F’, where ‘C’ is chapter number and ‘F’ is figure number. Figure number ‘F’ is reset back to 1 for each new chapter. 5. Page Sequence: (1) Cover page as per specimen 1 (2) Certificate page as per specimen 2 (3) Acknowledgement page for the help offered by individuals and institution (4) Content page as per specimen 3. Following suggested scheme of chapters in project report then follows these first 4 pages. Specimen of Pages Specimen 1 Project Title Diploma in Electronics and telecommunication (DETE) Submitted by Name of Student Project Guide Name of Project Guide Name of the Study Center Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University 2015 15 Specimen 2 Certificate This is to certify that Mr/Ms ................... .................... ..................... (PRN: ...................) has successfully completed a project entitled "..................................................." in partial fulfillment for the requirement of Diploma in Electronics and telecommunication (DETE) Signature with Date Project Guide SC Coordinator Internal Examiner External Examiner Specimen 3 Contents 1. Introduction 1.1 Background 1.2 Need for Work 1.3 Brief Idea 2. System Overview and Design 2.1 Operation 2.2 Design Parameters 2.3 System Design 3. Module Design and Implementation of Module 3.1 Module 1 3.2 Module 2 3.3 Module 3 4. Testing and Troubleshooting 4.1 Module 1 4.2 Module 1 4.3 Module 1 5. Results and Conclusions 5.1 Further Modifications 5.2 Summary 6. Reference LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 114 University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Title Author Edition Year ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14065-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14065-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14065-RB1 T14065–RB2 T14065–RB3 T14065–RB4 T14065–RB5 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14065-CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14065-WL1 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 115 T14066: ELECTRICAL TESTING AND MAINTENANCE AND A CTIVITY COURSE ON ELECTIVE 1 PROGRAMME INFORMATION SN Description Details 1 University Yashwantrao Chavan Maharashtra Open University Nasik - 422 222, Maharashtra, India Website: http://www.ycmou.ac.in/ 2 School School of Architecture, Science and Technology 3 Discipline Technology/Engineering 4 Level Diploma 5 Course Used in 01. V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering COURSE INFORMATION Sem PC CC 01 V55 T14066 Course Name Credit CST ST Marks Type 4 120 120 100 P Electrical Testing and Maintenance and Activity Course on Elective 1 Teaching-Learning Support Details: Students enjoy better quality of effective learning with much greater flexibility, due to anytime anywhere learning with repetition possibility! 1. ‘2 online SCORM lectures’ at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 2. Only when online SCORM lectures are not specified, then ‘2 face-to-face lectures (each of 45 minutes duration) at the beginning of Term work or Practical session at allotted SC’, for 15 weeks in a semester. 3. Each Term-Work or Practical session shall be of 240 minutes duration. Remaining time of 195 minutes after initial lectures of 45 minutes shall be used for actual conduct and reporting of Term-work/practical activities during each session. Evaluation Pattern: In total evaluation, Internal Examiner (IE) and External Examiner (EE) shall have 50% weightage. Total evaluation of 100 Marks consist of 1. Continuous Assessment (CA) (Only by IE): 20 Marks 2. End Examination (EE): 80 Marks a. Activity Report submission by the student (Only by EE): 20 Marks b. Actual Conduct of Practical by the student: 20 Marks (by EE) + 20 Marks (by IE) c. Viva on Practical Report/Activity: 10 Marks (by EE) + 10 Marks (by IE) PART I: T14063: ELECTRICAL TESTING AND MAINTENANCE PRESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND LEARNING OBJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Explore procedure used to Test Single Phase, Three Phase Transformer, DC & AC Machine as per IS Identify and perform common troubles in Electrical Machines and Switch Gear DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY Credit Block UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Course Content Covered in T14063: Electrical Testing and Maintenance Credit 01 02 Course Content Covered in T14063: Electrical Testing and Maintenance Credit 02 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity Credit Block Questions Perform any Five (5) activities 01 To Measure Voltage, Impedance and Load losses of Three phase Transformer 02 To Perform Routine Test on Single Phase Induction Motor 03 To Perform Routine Test on Three Phase Induction Motor and Calculate the Different Parameters 04 To Perform reduced voltage running up test on Three Phase Induction Motor as per IS 325 05 To perform Fault finding and troubleshooting of i) Transformer ii) D. C. Machine iii) Induction motor 06 To Perform No Load and Blocked Rotor Test on Three Phase Induction Motor as per IS 325. Draw Circle Diagram and Calculate Performance Indicator. 07 To Perform Polarity Test, Mark Its Terminals, Perform Back To Back Test for Two Single Phase Transformers, Compare its Regulation with Direct Loading Method Credit 01 Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Page 116 Perform any Five (5) activities To Perform a brake test on three phase induction motor and find out performance characteristics 08 such as Output Vs Torque, Output Vs Efficiency and Output Vs Speed 09 To Determine Breakdown Strength of Transformer Oil by using Oil Testing Kit. 10 To Measure Insulation resistance of Transformer Winding , Stator and Rotor of A.C. Rotating Machines using Megger 11 Prepare Preventive Maintenance Schedule for i) Distribution Transformer ii) Three Phase Induction Motor iii) Synchronous Motor 12 Use different Maintenance Tools such as Bearing Puller, Growler, Dial-Test Indicators, Filler Gauge, Spirit Level, etc 13 14 Perform OC & SC test on Induction Motor, Plot Circle Diagram and Calculate Parameters To Measure the Resistance of Earth Electrode using Earth Tester 15 Case Study on Electrical Accidents. Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units. Credit 02 LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books LR Code Edition Year Title Author ISBN Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14066-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14066-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Design and Testing of Electrical Machines 9788120336452 T14063 –RB1 2013 Deshpande, M. V PHI Learning Private Limited, Operation & Maintenance of Electrical Machines Vol – I, latest reprint Media Promoters & Publisher Ltd. Mumbai T14063 –RB2 B. V. S. Rao T14063 –RB3 Operation & Maintenance of Electrical Machines Vol – II, B. V. S. Rao latest reprint 8185099022 Media Promoters & Publisher Ltd. Mumbai T14063 –RB4 A Textbook of Electrical Technology: Volume II: AC & DC Machines , B. L. Theraja 23rd Revised Edition 8121924375 / 9788121924375 S. Chand & Company Ltd, New Delhi, India T14063 –RB5 Switchgear Protection and Power Systems, Sunil S Rao 2008 8174092323, 978-8174092328 Khanna 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14066-CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14066-WL1 http://electrical-engineering-portal.com/resources/electric-testingmaintenance PART II: ELECTIVE 1: T14064: ILLUMINATION ENGINEERING RESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND L EARNING O BJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to To Measure the Level of Illumination. To Explore various types of Lamps. To Design Illumination Schemes for various applications in Residential, Commercial and Industrial Locations. Identify and List of various Lighting Accessories and Components DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Course Content Covered in T14064: Illumination Engineering Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Credit Block Credit 01 Page 117 Credit 02 02 Course Content Covered in T14064: Illumination Engineering DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor Credit Block UN Name of the Practical Activity Perform any Five (5) activities 01 To measure illuminance at different points of a classroom by Luxmeter and draw – (i) Variation of Illuminance characteristics with distance and (ii) Isolux plot 02 To study the different lighting accessories, ignitor, and electronic ballasts required for different types of lamps – Sodium Vapour, Mercury Vapour, Metal halide, CFL and Fluorescent lamp. 03 To Compare performance of Magnetic and Electronic Ballast. Estimate the energy saving with Electronic Ballast. Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units Credit 01 04 To design an illumination scheme using LED 05 To design an illumination scheme for a workshop in your institute or conference hall of medium size 06 To design an illumination scheme for a stadium. Perform any Five (5) activities Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units 07 To design an illumination scheme for a shopping complex of medium size. 08 To study of i) Photocell ii) Occupancy sensor in artificial lighting control 09 To study Energy Efficient Illumination Equipments 10 To verify the Inverse Square Law and compare the difference in Output Luminescence of Incandescent, Fluorescent and Compact Fluorescent Lamps 11 To visit a Standard Lamp Manufacturing Industry and make a report on Lamp Manufacturing Process and the Technical Specification. Credit 02 12 A case Study Of Optimum Lighting Design with Lighting Design Software 13 To study the different luminaries available in the market for various types of lamps with their technical specifications, their design consideration, Indian standard recommendation LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14066-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14066-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Applied Illumination Engineering, 3rd 0824748093, 978-0824748098 T14064 –RB1 Jack L. Lindsey FIES Fairmont Press Lighting Engineering: Applied Calculations, December 978-0-7506-5051-9 T14064 –RB2 2000 R. H. Simons Architectural Press T14064 –RB3 Lamps and Lighting, M. A. Cayless, A. M. Marsden 4th 2011 9780415503082, Routledge T14064 –RB4 Illumination engineering: from Edison's lamp to the laser, Joseph B. Murdoch Illustrated print 1885750005, 9781885750006 Visions Communications Utilisation of Electric Power : Including Electric Drives and Electric 2nd Traction, 2014 Suryanarayana, N.V. 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14066 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14066-WL1 T14064 –RB5 978-81-224-3681-5 New Age International PART II: ELECTIVE 1: T15064: MODERN ELECTRIC TRACTION Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 118 RESUMED KNOWLEDGE AND L EARNING O BJECTIVES Presumed Knowledge Learning Objectives For successful completion of this course, student should have successfully completed: After successful completion of this course, student should be able to Identify and Explain use of Components of the Power Supply Arrangements for Electric Traction Know basics of Electric Traction Do Electric Locomotive Maintenance DETAIL SYLLABUS OF R EQUIRED THEORY Credit Block UN Detail Syllabus of the Unit 01 Course Content Covered in T15064: Modern Electric Traction Credit 01 02 Course Content Covered in T15064: Modern Electric Traction Credit 02 DETAIL PRACTICAL ACTIVITIES Note: Work Book shall consist of a record in the form of a journal consisting of the list of activities, printouts and necessary documentation for the following exercises. Students are expected to perform all activities and get workbook certified from the Practical Lab Instructor UN Name of the Practical Activity Credit Block Perform following activities 01 To study of Electric AC Locomotives 02 To study of Different types of Relays, Contactors used in AC Locomotive 03 To prepare drawing on half Imperial for Traction Substation Layout or Feeding Post Layout and submit Credit 01 report on it 04 To prepare drawing on half Imperial for Overhead Equipments (OHE) and Current Collecting Equipments and submit report on it Questions Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units 05 To prepare drawing on half Imperial for Power Circuit any Electric Locomotive and submit report on it Perform following activities 06 To prepare drawing on half Imperial for Signaling and Train Lighting and submit report on it 07 To prepare drawing on half Imperial for Power Circuit in Auxiliary Circuit Equipments and submit report Credit 02 on it Students have to submit ‘Activity Report in Work-Book Format’ in CA and Perform ‘Practical Activity’ and face Viva for end exam on these units 08 To prepare drawing on half Imperial for Protection of Electric Locomotive 09 To Collect information on any two topics related to electric traction and submission of printouts 10 To visit nearby Traction Substation/Feeding Post/Railway Station(Signaling or Traction) LEARNING RESOURCE DETAILS Important Note- End exam shall be based on only following types of specified learning resource: 1. Online Audio-Video (AV) Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture and / or 2. Text-Books University does not supply any learning resource. Each student is required to purchase following at an additional separate cost: 1. Subscription to ‘Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures’ for a semester and 2. Text-Books Title Edition ISBN LR Code Author Year Publisher 01. Online AV Synchronized SCORM Lectures along with Self-Test with each lecture: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14066-OL1 Details will be updated as and when available from the publishers. 02. Text-Books: Core learning resource for end Exam! T14066-TB1 03. Reference-Books: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! Modern Electric Traction, 4th Book Code : 006527 of Jain Book Depo T15064 –RB1 H Partab 2015 Dhanpat Rai and Sons Viddut Engine Parichay (In Hindi) S. P. Graphics, Nashik. T15064 –RB2 Om Prakash Kesari Electric Traction 2009 8177640054, 9788177640052 T15064 –RB3 by J. Upadhyay, Mehendra Allied Publishers Pvt. Ltd. T15064 –RB4 Electric traction handbook : control Brooks, Robert Sir Isaac Pitman and sons ltd. London T15064 –RB5 Utilisation of Electric Power:Including Electric Drives&Electric Traction, 2nd Suryanarayana, N.V 2014 978-81-224-3681-5 New Age International Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 119 Electric Traction A.T. Dover Mac millan, 04. CD / DVD: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14066 -CD1 05. Web Links: Explore additional details and reinforce learning, with this optional learning resource! T14066-WL1 T15064 –RB6 Dhanpat Rai and Sons, New Delhi END OF DOCUMENT Detail Syllabus for all courses at Semester 01 - 06 of V55: Diploma in Electrical Engineering (DEE) {2014 Pattern} Page 120
© Copyright 2025 Paperzz